1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GDB.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "continuations.h"
66 #include "dummy-frame.h"
69 #include "thread-fsm.h"
70 #include "tid-parse.h"
72 /* readline include files */
73 #include "readline/readline.h"
74 #include "readline/history.h"
76 /* readline defines this. */
79 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
80 #include "extension.h"
82 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
83 #include "common/array-view.h"
84 #include "common/gdb_optional.h"
86 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
87 enum exception_event_kind
94 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
96 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
97 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
99 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
102 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
103 struct linespec_result *canonical,
104 enum bptype type_wanted);
106 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
107 struct linespec_result *,
108 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
109 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
111 enum bpdisp, int, int,
113 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
114 int, int, int, unsigned);
116 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
117 (struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
118 struct program_space *search_pspace);
120 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
121 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
123 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
125 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
127 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
128 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
129 const struct symtab_and_line *);
131 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
133 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
134 struct symtab_and_line,
136 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
138 static struct breakpoint *
139 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
141 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
144 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
146 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
150 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
151 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
152 struct obj_section *, int);
154 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
155 struct bp_location *loc2);
157 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
158 const struct address_space *aspace,
161 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
162 const address_space *,
165 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
166 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
168 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
170 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
172 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
174 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
176 int *other_type_used);
178 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
181 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
182 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
183 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
185 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
187 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
188 insert locations now. */
189 enum ugll_insert_mode
191 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
192 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
193 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
194 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
195 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
196 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
197 returns true on them.
199 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
200 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
201 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
202 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
203 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
204 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
208 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
209 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
212 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
213 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
214 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
215 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
216 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
217 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
218 as no thread is running yet. */
222 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
224 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
226 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
228 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
230 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
232 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
234 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
236 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
238 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
241 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
243 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
244 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
245 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
246 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
248 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
249 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
251 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
252 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
254 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
256 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
258 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
259 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
261 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
262 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
264 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
265 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
266 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
267 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
268 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
269 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
271 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
272 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
273 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
274 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
280 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
282 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
283 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
284 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
285 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
287 static char *dprintf_function;
289 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
290 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
291 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
292 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
293 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
294 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
295 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
297 static char *dprintf_channel;
299 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
301 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
303 struct command_line *
304 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
306 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
309 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
310 current breakpoint. */
312 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
315 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
317 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
318 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
320 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
322 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
325 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
326 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
327 if such is available. */
328 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
331 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
332 struct cmd_list_element *c,
335 fprintf_filtered (file,
336 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
337 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
341 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
342 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
343 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
344 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
345 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
347 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
348 struct cmd_list_element *c,
351 fprintf_filtered (file,
352 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
353 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
357 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
358 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
359 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
360 use hardware breakpoints. */
361 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
363 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
364 struct cmd_list_element *c,
367 fprintf_filtered (file,
368 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
372 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
373 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
374 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
375 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
376 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
377 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
378 processing user input. */
379 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
382 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
383 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
385 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
389 /* See breakpoint.h. */
392 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
394 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
396 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
397 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
398 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
401 else if (target_has_execution)
403 struct thread_info *tp;
405 if (always_inserted_mode)
407 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
412 if (threads_are_executing ())
415 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
416 stopped, we still have events to process. */
417 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
419 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
425 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
427 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
428 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
429 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
430 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
431 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
432 condition_evaluation_auto,
433 condition_evaluation_host,
434 condition_evaluation_target,
438 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
439 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
441 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
442 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
443 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
445 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
446 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
447 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
451 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
453 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
455 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
456 return condition_evaluation_target;
458 return condition_evaluation_host;
464 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
467 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
469 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
472 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
476 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
478 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
480 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
483 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
484 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
486 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
487 static int overlay_events_enabled;
489 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
490 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
492 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
493 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
494 current breakpoint. */
496 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
498 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
499 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
500 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
503 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
504 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
505 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
507 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
508 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
509 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
512 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
513 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
514 to where the loop should start from.
515 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
516 appropriate location to start with. */
518 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
519 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
520 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
522 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
523 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
526 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
528 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
529 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
530 if (is_tracepoint (B))
532 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
534 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
536 /* Array is sorted by bp_locations_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
538 static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
540 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
542 static unsigned bp_locations_count;
544 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
545 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
546 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
547 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
548 an address you need to read. */
550 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
552 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
553 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
554 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
555 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
556 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
558 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
560 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
561 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
562 reported by a target. */
563 static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
565 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
567 static int breakpoint_count;
569 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
570 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
571 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
572 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
573 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
575 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
577 static int tracepoint_count;
579 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
580 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
581 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
583 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
586 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
589 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
593 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
600 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
602 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
604 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
607 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
610 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
612 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
613 breakpoint_count = num;
614 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
617 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
618 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
619 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
621 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
624 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
626 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
629 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
632 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
634 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
637 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
640 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
642 struct breakpoint *b;
649 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
650 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
653 get_breakpoint (int num)
655 struct breakpoint *b;
658 if (b->number == num)
666 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
667 evaluating conditions on its side. */
670 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
672 struct bp_location *loc;
674 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
675 evaluating conditions and if the user has
676 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
678 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
679 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
682 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
685 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
686 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
689 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
690 evaluating conditions on its side. */
693 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
695 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
696 evaluating conditions and if the user has
697 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
699 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
700 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
704 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
707 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
710 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
711 condition_evaluation_mode. */
714 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
715 struct cmd_list_element *c)
717 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
719 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
720 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
722 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
723 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
724 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
728 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
729 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
731 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
732 settings was "auto". */
733 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
735 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
736 if (new_mode != old_mode)
738 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
739 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
740 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
742 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
743 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
746 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
748 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
750 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
751 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
755 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
756 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
757 target knows about. */
758 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
759 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
760 loc->needs_update = 1;
764 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
770 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
771 what "auto" is translating to. */
774 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
775 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
777 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
778 fprintf_filtered (file,
779 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
780 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
782 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
784 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
788 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
789 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
790 the more general bp_locations_compare function. */
793 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
795 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
796 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
798 if (a->address == b->address)
801 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
804 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
805 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
806 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
809 static struct bp_location **
810 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
812 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
813 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
814 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
816 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
817 dummy_loc.address = address;
819 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
820 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
821 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
822 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
823 bp_locations_compare_addrs));
825 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
826 if (locp_found == NULL)
829 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
830 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
831 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
832 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
839 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
842 xfree (b->cond_string);
843 b->cond_string = NULL;
845 if (is_watchpoint (b))
847 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
849 w->cond_exp.reset ();
853 struct bp_location *loc;
855 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
859 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
860 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
861 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
868 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
872 const char *arg = exp;
874 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
875 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
876 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
877 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
879 if (is_watchpoint (b))
881 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
883 innermost_block.reset ();
885 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
887 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
888 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
892 struct bp_location *loc;
894 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
898 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
899 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
901 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
905 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
907 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
910 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
913 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
914 completion_tracker &tracker,
915 const char *text, const char *word)
919 text = skip_spaces (text);
920 space = skip_to_space (text);
924 struct breakpoint *b;
928 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
929 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
930 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
934 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
941 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
943 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
945 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> copy (xstrdup (number));
946 tracker.add_completion (std::move (copy));
953 /* We're completing the expression part. */
954 text = skip_spaces (space);
955 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
958 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
961 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
963 struct breakpoint *b;
968 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
971 bnum = get_number (&p);
973 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
976 if (b->number == bnum)
978 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
979 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
980 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
981 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
982 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
986 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
987 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
988 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
990 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
992 if (is_breakpoint (b))
993 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
998 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1001 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1002 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1003 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1006 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1008 struct command_line *c;
1010 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1012 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1013 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1014 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1016 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1017 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1019 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1020 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1021 command directly. */
1022 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1023 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1025 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1026 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1030 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1032 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1035 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1038 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1040 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1041 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1042 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1046 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1048 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1052 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1054 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1057 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1060 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1061 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1065 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1066 b = new tracepoint ();
1067 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1068 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1070 b = new breakpoint ();
1072 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1075 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1076 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1080 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1081 struct command_line *commands)
1083 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1085 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1086 struct command_line *c;
1087 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1089 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1090 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1094 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1095 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1096 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1097 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1098 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1099 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1100 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1101 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1102 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1103 tracepoint's context. */
1104 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1106 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1108 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1109 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1110 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1111 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1112 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1113 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1116 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1117 "can be used only once"));
1122 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1126 struct command_line *c2;
1128 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1129 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1130 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1132 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1133 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1139 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1143 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1144 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1146 std::vector<breakpoint *>
1147 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1149 struct breakpoint *b;
1150 std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
1151 struct bp_location *loc;
1154 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1156 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1157 if (loc->address == addr)
1158 found.push_back (b);
1164 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1165 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1168 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1169 counted_command_line &&commands)
1171 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1173 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1174 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1177 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1178 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1182 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1184 int old_silent = b->silent;
1187 if (old_silent != silent)
1188 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1191 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1192 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1195 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1197 int old_thread = b->thread;
1200 if (old_thread != thread)
1201 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1204 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1205 breakpoint work for any task. */
1208 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1210 int old_task = b->task;
1213 if (old_task != task)
1214 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1218 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1219 struct command_line *control)
1221 counted_command_line cmd;
1222 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1223 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1224 list of command by just typing "end". */
1225 bool cmd_read = false;
1227 std::string new_arg;
1229 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1231 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1232 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1234 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1235 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1236 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1239 map_breakpoint_numbers
1240 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1244 gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
1245 if (control != NULL)
1246 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1250 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1251 "%s, one per line."),
1254 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1256 validate_actionline (line, b);
1258 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1259 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1260 validator = do_validate;
1262 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1267 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1269 if (b->commands != cmd)
1271 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1273 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1279 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1281 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1284 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1285 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1287 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1288 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1289 enum command_control_type
1290 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1292 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1293 return simple_control;
1296 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1299 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1301 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1305 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1306 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1311 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1312 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1315 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1316 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1317 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1320 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1321 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1322 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1323 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1324 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1326 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1327 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1331 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1332 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1334 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1338 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1340 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1341 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1343 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1345 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1350 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1352 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1357 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1358 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1360 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1361 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1362 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1366 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1368 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1369 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1372 if (readbuf != NULL)
1374 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1375 shadow_contents buffer. */
1376 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1377 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1378 + target_info->shadow_len));
1380 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1382 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1383 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1387 const unsigned char *bp;
1388 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1391 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1392 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1393 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1395 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1397 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1399 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1400 breakpoint's INSN. */
1401 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1405 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1406 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1408 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1409 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1410 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1412 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1413 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1414 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1415 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1416 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1417 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1418 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1419 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1421 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1424 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1425 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1426 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1428 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1430 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1432 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1433 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1434 report higher one. */
1437 bc_r = bp_locations_count;
1438 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1440 struct bp_location *bl;
1442 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1443 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1445 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1446 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1447 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1448 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1450 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1451 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1452 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1454 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1456 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1463 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1464 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1465 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1466 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1467 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1470 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1472 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1473 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1474 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1477 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1480 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1482 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
1484 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1486 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1487 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1488 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1491 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1494 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1495 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1496 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
1499 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1502 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1503 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1509 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1513 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1515 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1516 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1517 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1520 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1523 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1525 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1526 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1527 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1530 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1534 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1536 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1537 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1540 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1541 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1542 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1543 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1544 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1545 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1546 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1547 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1550 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1552 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1553 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1554 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1555 && !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
1558 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1559 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1562 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1564 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1566 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1567 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1568 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1569 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1570 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1572 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1575 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1578 static struct value *
1579 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1581 struct value *bit_val;
1586 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1588 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1591 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1598 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1599 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1600 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1601 to be able to report stops. */
1604 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1605 struct program_space *pspace)
1607 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1609 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1610 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1611 b->loc->address = -1;
1612 b->loc->length = -1;
1615 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1616 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1619 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1621 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1623 && b->loc->next == NULL
1624 && b->loc->address == -1
1625 && b->loc->length == -1);
1628 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1629 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1630 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1631 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1633 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1635 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1636 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1639 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1640 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1641 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1642 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1643 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1644 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1645 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1646 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1648 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1649 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1650 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1651 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1652 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1653 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1654 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1655 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1658 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1659 hardware watchpoints:
1661 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1662 called several times when GDB stops.
1665 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1666 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1667 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1668 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1669 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1670 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1671 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1672 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1673 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1674 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1675 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1677 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1678 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1681 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1683 int within_current_scope;
1684 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1687 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1688 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1689 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1690 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1693 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1698 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1699 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1700 within_current_scope = 1;
1703 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1704 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1705 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1707 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1708 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1709 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1710 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1711 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1714 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1715 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1716 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1717 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1720 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1722 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1723 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1724 if (within_current_scope)
1728 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1729 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1730 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1733 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1738 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1739 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1740 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1741 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1742 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1743 be completely different objects. */
1747 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1748 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1749 locations (re)created below. */
1750 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1752 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1755 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1759 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1760 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1761 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1762 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1763 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1764 if (!target_has_execution)
1766 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1767 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1768 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1769 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1771 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1772 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1774 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1775 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1778 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1781 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1782 struct value *v, *result;
1783 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1785 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1787 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1788 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1789 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1790 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1791 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1793 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1795 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1796 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1797 b->val = release_value (v);
1801 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1803 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1804 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1805 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1809 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1810 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1811 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1812 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1813 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1814 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1815 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1817 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1819 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1820 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1821 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1823 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1824 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1827 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1828 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1829 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1831 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1833 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1835 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1836 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1838 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1840 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1841 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1842 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1843 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1844 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1847 addr = value_address (v);
1850 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1855 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1857 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1860 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1861 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1864 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1866 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1867 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1871 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1872 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1875 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1877 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1882 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1883 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1884 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1889 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1890 struct bp_location *bl;
1892 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1896 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1899 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1900 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1901 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1903 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1904 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1905 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1906 this watchpoint in as well. */
1908 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1909 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1910 hardware watchpoint type. */
1912 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1913 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1915 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1916 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1917 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1918 through watch_command), so always account for it
1921 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1922 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
1924 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1925 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
1928 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1929 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1931 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
1933 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1934 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1935 "hardware watchpoint."));
1936 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1937 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1938 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1940 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1941 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1945 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1946 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1947 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1952 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1954 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1955 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1956 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1958 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1959 "read/access watchpoint."));
1962 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1964 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1965 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1966 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1967 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1970 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1971 above left it without any location set up. But,
1972 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1973 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1974 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1975 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
1977 else if (!within_current_scope)
1979 printf_filtered (_("\
1980 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1981 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1983 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
1986 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1988 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1992 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1993 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
1994 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
1995 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
1996 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
1998 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2000 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2003 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2006 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2009 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2012 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2013 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2014 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2015 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2016 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2017 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2018 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2019 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2020 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2023 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2024 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2025 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2027 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2028 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2029 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2031 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2032 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2033 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2034 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2035 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2036 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2037 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2038 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2039 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2043 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2044 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2045 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2046 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2051 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2052 instruction that triggered one. */
2053 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2054 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2058 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2059 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2060 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2061 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2070 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2071 that the location is not duplicated. */
2074 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2077 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2080 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2081 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2085 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2086 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2087 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2088 any error during parsing. */
2090 static agent_expr_up
2091 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2096 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2098 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2099 that may show up. */
2102 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2105 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2107 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2108 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2109 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2113 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2117 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2118 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2119 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2120 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2121 one of them is true. */
2124 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2126 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2127 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2128 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2129 struct bp_location *loc;
2131 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2132 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2134 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2135 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2136 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2138 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2139 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2142 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2143 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2144 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2145 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2146 response back to GDB. */
2147 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2150 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2154 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2155 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2156 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2157 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2158 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2162 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2163 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2164 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2166 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2172 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2173 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2174 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2176 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2177 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2178 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2180 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2183 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2185 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2187 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2190 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2195 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2196 for this location's address. */
2197 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2201 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2202 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2203 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2206 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2207 to send the conditions to the target. */
2208 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2215 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2216 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2217 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2219 static agent_expr_up
2220 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2222 const char *cmdrest;
2223 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2224 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2231 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2233 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2235 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2236 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2238 format_start = cmdrest;
2240 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2242 format_end = cmdrest;
2244 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2245 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2247 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2249 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2250 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2252 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2254 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2256 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2258 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2259 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2264 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2265 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2267 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2271 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2273 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2274 that may show up. */
2277 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2278 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2279 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2281 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2283 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2284 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2285 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2289 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2293 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2294 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2295 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2298 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2300 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2301 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2302 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2303 struct bp_location *loc;
2305 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2306 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2308 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2311 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2312 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2315 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2316 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2317 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2319 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2322 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2323 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2324 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2328 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2329 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2330 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2331 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2332 response back to GDB. */
2333 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2336 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2340 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2341 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2342 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2343 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2345 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2346 loc->owner->extra_string);
2349 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2350 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2351 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2353 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2359 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2361 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2363 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2366 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2367 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2369 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2371 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2374 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2379 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2380 for this location's address. */
2381 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2384 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2385 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2386 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2387 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2390 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2391 to send the commands to the target. */
2392 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2396 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2397 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2398 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2399 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2402 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2403 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2404 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2408 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2410 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2412 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2413 struct regcache *regcache;
2415 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2417 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2421 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2424 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2425 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2426 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2427 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2430 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2431 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2433 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2434 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2435 int *disabled_breaks,
2436 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2437 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2439 gdb_exception bp_excpt = exception_none;
2441 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2444 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2445 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2446 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2447 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2448 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2449 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2450 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2451 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2452 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2453 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2454 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2455 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2457 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2458 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2459 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2460 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2462 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2464 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2465 build_target_command_list (bl);
2466 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2467 bl->needs_update = 0;
2470 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2471 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2473 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2475 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2476 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2477 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2479 Two important cases are:
2480 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2481 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2482 hardware breakpoint.
2483 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2484 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2485 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2488 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2489 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2490 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2491 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2493 struct mem_region *mr
2494 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2498 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2500 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2502 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2503 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2505 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2507 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2509 static int said = 0;
2511 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2514 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2515 _("Note: automatically using "
2516 "hardware breakpoints for "
2517 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2522 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2523 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2525 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2526 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2527 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2528 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2530 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2536 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2537 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2538 || bl->section == NULL
2539 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2541 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2546 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2548 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2550 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2558 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2559 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2560 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2562 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2563 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2564 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2565 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2566 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2570 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2572 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2573 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2574 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2576 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2581 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2582 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2583 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2584 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2585 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2588 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2590 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2596 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2597 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2598 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2599 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2603 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2604 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2606 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2611 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2613 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2615 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2623 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2624 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2629 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2631 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2633 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2634 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2635 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2636 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2637 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2638 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2639 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2640 errors as memory errors. */
2641 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2642 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2643 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2644 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2645 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2646 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2649 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2650 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2651 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2652 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2654 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2655 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2657 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2658 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2659 "library breakpoints:\n");
2661 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2662 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2663 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2668 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2670 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2671 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2672 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2673 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2675 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2676 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2677 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2682 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2685 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2686 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2688 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2689 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2691 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2695 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2696 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2711 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2712 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2713 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2714 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2718 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2719 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2721 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2723 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2724 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2725 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2727 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2729 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2730 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2732 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2734 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2735 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2739 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2740 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2747 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2748 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2751 /* Back to the original value. */
2752 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2756 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2759 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2763 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2764 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2766 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2769 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2773 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2774 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2776 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2779 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2781 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2782 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2783 so just return success. */
2790 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2791 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2795 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2797 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2798 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2800 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2801 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2803 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2804 delete_breakpoint (b);
2807 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2808 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2809 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2811 struct bp_location *tmp;
2813 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2815 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2816 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2817 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2819 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2820 if (tmp->next == loc)
2822 tmp->next = loc->next;
2828 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2829 removed locations above. */
2830 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2833 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2834 Throws exception on any error.
2835 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2836 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2838 insert_breakpoints (void)
2840 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2842 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2843 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2845 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2847 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2850 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2851 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2852 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2853 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2856 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2859 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2861 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2863 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2865 callback (loc, NULL);
2869 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2870 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2871 always-inserted mode. */
2874 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2876 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2879 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2880 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2881 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2883 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2885 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2886 there was an error. */
2887 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2889 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2891 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2893 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2895 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2898 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2899 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2900 deletion of breakpoints. */
2901 if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
2904 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2906 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2907 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2908 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2909 insert breakpoints. */
2910 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2911 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2914 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2915 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2922 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2923 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2927 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2930 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2932 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2933 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2936 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2937 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2938 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2940 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2942 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2943 there was an error. */
2944 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2946 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2948 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2950 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2953 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2954 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2955 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2956 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2957 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2960 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2962 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2963 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2964 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2965 insert breakpoints. */
2966 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2967 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2970 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2971 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
2976 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2977 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2978 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2980 int some_failed = 0;
2981 struct bp_location *loc;
2983 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2986 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2989 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2992 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2993 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3000 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3002 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3004 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3005 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3006 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3014 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3015 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3016 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3018 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3019 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3021 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3022 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3026 /* Used when the program stops.
3027 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3028 removing a breakpoint location. */
3031 remove_breakpoints (void)
3033 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3036 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3038 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3039 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3044 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3048 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3050 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3052 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3054 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3056 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3058 printf_filtered (_("\
3059 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3060 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3062 /* Hide it from the user. */
3068 /* Remove breakpoints of inferior INF. */
3071 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3073 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3076 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3078 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3081 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3083 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3091 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3093 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3094 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3095 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3096 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3097 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3098 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3100 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3103 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3106 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3107 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3111 static struct breakpoint *
3112 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3113 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3114 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3116 symtab_and_line sal;
3118 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3119 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3121 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3122 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3123 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3128 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3130 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3132 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3134 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3135 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3137 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3138 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3140 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3141 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3143 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3144 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3146 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3148 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3150 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3151 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3153 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3154 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3156 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3157 int exception_searched = 0;
3159 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3161 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3164 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3166 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3167 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3169 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3172 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3174 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3177 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3178 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3180 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3181 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3183 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3185 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3186 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3187 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3189 bp_objfile_data = new breakpoint_objfile_data ();
3190 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3192 return bp_objfile_data;
3196 free_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3198 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3199 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3201 delete bp_objfile_data;
3205 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3207 struct objfile *objfile;
3208 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3210 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3212 struct breakpoint *b;
3213 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3215 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3217 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3219 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3222 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3224 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3226 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3227 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3229 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3230 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3233 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3236 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3237 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3239 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3240 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3241 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3242 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3244 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3246 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3247 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3251 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3252 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3258 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3260 struct program_space *pspace;
3262 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3264 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3266 struct objfile *objfile;
3268 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3270 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3273 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3274 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3276 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3278 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3280 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3282 std::vector<probe *> ret
3283 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3287 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3290 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3292 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3293 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3297 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3298 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3301 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3303 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3305 struct breakpoint *b;
3307 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3308 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3310 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3311 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3312 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3318 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3321 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3323 struct breakpoint *b;
3324 const char *func_name;
3326 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3328 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3331 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3332 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3334 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3336 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3337 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3339 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3340 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3343 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3346 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3347 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3348 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3349 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3350 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3351 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3352 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3358 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3360 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3362 struct program_space *pspace;
3363 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3365 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3367 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3369 struct objfile *objfile;
3372 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3374 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3376 struct breakpoint *b;
3377 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3378 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3380 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3382 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3385 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3387 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3389 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3390 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3391 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3393 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3394 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3397 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3400 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3401 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3402 bp_std_terminate_master,
3403 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3404 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3405 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3406 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3407 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3412 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3415 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3417 struct objfile *objfile;
3418 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3420 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3422 struct breakpoint *b;
3423 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3424 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3426 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3428 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3430 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3431 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3433 std::vector<probe *> ret
3434 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3438 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3441 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3443 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3444 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3448 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3449 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3452 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3454 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3456 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3458 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3459 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3460 bp_exception_master,
3461 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3462 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3463 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3469 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3471 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3474 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3476 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3478 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3480 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3481 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3483 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3487 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3490 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3491 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3492 current_top_target ());
3493 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3494 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3495 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3496 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3497 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3498 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3502 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3505 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3507 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3511 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3513 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3514 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3516 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3517 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3518 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3519 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3520 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3521 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3522 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3523 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3524 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3525 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3526 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3528 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3530 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3533 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3534 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3536 delete_breakpoint (b);
3540 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3541 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3543 delete_breakpoint (b);
3547 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3548 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3549 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3550 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3551 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3553 delete_breakpoint (b);
3557 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3558 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3560 delete_breakpoint (b);
3564 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3565 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3567 delete_breakpoint (b);
3571 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3573 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3574 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3575 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3577 delete_breakpoint (b);
3581 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3583 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3584 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3585 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3586 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3590 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3591 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3592 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3593 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3594 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3595 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3597 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3598 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3599 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3600 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3601 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3602 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3603 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3605 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3606 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3607 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3608 let finish_command delete it.
3610 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3611 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3612 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3613 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3614 solib breakpoints.) */
3616 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3621 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3622 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3624 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3626 delete_breakpoint (b);
3633 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3635 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3637 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3638 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3640 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3641 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3643 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3644 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3645 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3647 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3650 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3651 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3652 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3653 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3654 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3655 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3656 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3660 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3666 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3667 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3668 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3669 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3670 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3673 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3677 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3678 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3680 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3681 This should not ever happen. */
3682 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3684 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3685 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3687 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3688 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3689 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3691 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3692 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3693 || bl->section == NULL
3694 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3696 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3698 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3699 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3700 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3701 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3702 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3703 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3704 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3705 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3706 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3707 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3708 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3709 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3710 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3711 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3712 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3713 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3714 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3715 they should always be removed. */
3716 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3717 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3718 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3721 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3725 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3726 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3727 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3729 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3730 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3732 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3733 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3734 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3735 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3736 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3738 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3739 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3742 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3743 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3746 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3747 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3748 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3749 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3751 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3752 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3753 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3754 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3755 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3756 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3762 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3767 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3768 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3769 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3770 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3771 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3772 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3773 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3774 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3775 always-inserted mode. */
3777 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3778 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3779 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3780 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3786 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3788 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3790 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3791 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3793 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3794 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3796 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3797 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3798 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3801 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3802 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3805 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3806 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3808 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3812 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3819 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3821 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3822 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3824 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3825 This should not ever happen. */
3826 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3828 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3830 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3832 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3835 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3838 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3840 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3842 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3843 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3847 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3848 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3850 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3853 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3854 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3855 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3860 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3862 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3863 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3865 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3867 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3870 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3872 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3874 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3880 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3882 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3883 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3886 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3888 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3890 case bp_shlib_event:
3892 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3893 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3894 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3895 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3896 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3898 (gdb) file prog-linux
3899 (gdb) run # native linux target
3902 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3903 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3906 case bp_step_resume:
3908 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3910 case bp_single_step:
3912 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3914 delete_breakpoint (b);
3918 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3919 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3920 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3922 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3924 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3925 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3926 delete_breakpoint (b);
3929 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3930 valid. New ones will be created in
3931 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3932 The next update_global_location_list call will
3933 garbage collect them. */
3936 if (context == inf_starting)
3938 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3939 insert_breakpoints. */
3940 w->val.reset (nullptr);
3951 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3952 for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
3953 decref_bp_location (&bl);
3954 moribund_locations.clear ();
3957 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3958 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3959 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3960 match, not program space. */
3962 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3963 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3964 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3965 permanent breakpoint.
3966 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3967 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3968 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3969 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3970 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3972 enum breakpoint_here
3973 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3975 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3976 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
3978 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3980 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3981 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3984 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3985 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3987 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3989 if (overlay_debugging
3990 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3991 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3992 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3993 else if (bl->permanent)
3994 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
3996 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4000 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4003 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4006 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4007 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4009 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4011 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4013 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4014 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4017 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4019 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4022 if (overlay_debugging
4023 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4024 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4026 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4037 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4040 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4042 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
4043 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4049 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4053 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4054 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4057 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4060 if (overlay_debugging
4061 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4062 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4063 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4070 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4073 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4075 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4077 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4079 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4081 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4082 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4085 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4091 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4095 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4098 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4100 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4102 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4104 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4107 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4114 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4117 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4120 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4122 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4124 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4126 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4129 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4137 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4138 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4140 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4142 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4144 struct bp_location *loc;
4146 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4147 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4150 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4153 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4154 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4158 /* Check for intersection. */
4159 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4160 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4169 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4173 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4175 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4178 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4181 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4183 if (bp_location_at != NULL)
4184 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
4187 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4188 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4191 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4208 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4210 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4211 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4212 commands (other.commands),
4213 print (other.print),
4215 print_it (other.print_it)
4217 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4218 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4219 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
4222 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4223 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4226 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4230 bpstat retval = NULL;
4235 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4237 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4240 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4250 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4253 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4258 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4260 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4266 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4269 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4271 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4273 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4275 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4277 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4282 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4291 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4292 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4293 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4294 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4296 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4297 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4299 Return 1 otherwise. */
4302 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4304 struct breakpoint *b;
4307 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4309 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4310 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4311 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4312 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4313 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4315 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4317 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4321 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4324 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4328 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4331 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4332 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4334 bs->commands = NULL;
4335 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4339 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4342 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4344 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4346 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4348 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4349 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4350 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4351 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4352 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4356 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4359 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4360 or its equivalent. */
4363 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4365 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4368 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4369 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4370 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4371 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4373 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4374 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4375 bpstat of the current thread. */
4378 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4383 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4385 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4388 scoped_restore save_executing
4389 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4391 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4393 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4396 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4397 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4399 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4401 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4403 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4404 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4405 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4406 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4407 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4408 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4409 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4410 the tree when we're done. */
4411 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4412 bs->commands = NULL;
4415 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4417 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4423 execute_control_command (cmd);
4425 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4431 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4433 if (current_ui->async)
4434 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4435 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4436 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4439 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4440 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4441 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4442 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4443 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4444 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4445 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4446 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4447 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4448 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4449 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4450 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4451 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4459 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4460 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4462 static thread_info *
4463 get_bpstat_thread ()
4465 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution)
4468 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4469 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
4475 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4477 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4480 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4481 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4483 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4484 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4485 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4486 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4487 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4491 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4494 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4497 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4500 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4503 struct value_print_options opts;
4504 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4505 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4509 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4510 debugging multiple threads. */
4513 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4515 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4520 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4523 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4525 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4526 uiout->field_fmt ("thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4528 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4531 uiout->text (" \"");
4532 uiout->field_fmt ("name", "%s", name);
4536 uiout->text (" hit ");
4540 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4541 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4542 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4543 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4546 static enum print_stop_action
4547 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4549 switch (bs->print_it)
4552 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4553 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4557 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4558 relevant messages. */
4559 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4562 case print_it_normal:
4564 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4566 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4567 which has since been deleted. */
4569 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4571 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4572 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4577 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4578 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4583 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4586 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4588 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4589 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4593 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4594 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4596 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4597 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4600 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4601 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4602 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4606 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4607 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4608 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4610 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4613 current_uiout->text (" ");
4614 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4615 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4621 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4622 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4624 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4627 current_uiout->text (" ");
4629 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4630 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4635 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4636 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4637 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4638 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4639 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4640 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4641 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4644 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4645 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4646 code to print the location. An example is
4647 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4649 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4650 to also print the location part of the message.
4651 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4652 don't require a location appended to the end.
4653 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4654 further info to be printed. */
4656 enum print_stop_action
4657 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4659 enum print_stop_action val;
4661 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4662 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4663 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4664 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4665 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4667 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4668 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4669 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4670 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4674 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4675 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4676 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4677 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4679 print_solib_event (0);
4680 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4683 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4684 with and nothing was printed. */
4685 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4688 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4691 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4693 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4694 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4696 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4700 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4702 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4704 bp_location_at (bl),
4705 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4709 print_it (print_it_normal)
4711 incref_bp_location (bl);
4712 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4713 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4718 bp_location_at (NULL),
4719 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4723 print_it (print_it_normal)
4727 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4728 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4731 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4733 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4735 struct breakpoint *b;
4737 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4739 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4740 as not triggered. */
4742 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4744 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4746 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4752 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_top_target (), &addr))
4754 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4755 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4757 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4759 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4761 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4767 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4768 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4772 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4774 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4775 struct bp_location *loc;
4777 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4778 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4780 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4782 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4783 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4785 if (newaddr == start)
4787 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4791 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4792 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (current_top_target (),
4796 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4805 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4806 enum wp_check_result
4808 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4811 /* The value has changed. */
4812 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4814 /* The value has not changed. */
4815 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4817 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4821 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4822 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4824 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4827 static wp_check_result
4828 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4830 struct watchpoint *b;
4831 struct frame_info *fr;
4832 int within_current_scope;
4834 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4835 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4836 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4838 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4839 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4840 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4841 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4844 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4845 within_current_scope = 1;
4848 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4849 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4850 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4852 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4853 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4854 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4855 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4856 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4857 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4858 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4859 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4860 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4861 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4864 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4865 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4867 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4868 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4869 if (within_current_scope)
4871 struct symbol *function;
4873 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4874 if (function == NULL
4875 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4876 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4877 within_current_scope = 0;
4880 if (within_current_scope)
4881 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4882 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4887 if (within_current_scope)
4889 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4890 time before we return to the command level and call
4891 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4892 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4896 struct value *new_val;
4898 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4899 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4900 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4901 a mask watchpoint. */
4902 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4904 mark = value_mark ();
4905 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
4907 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4908 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4910 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4911 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4912 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4913 not what we want. */
4914 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4915 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4918 bs->old_val = b->val;
4919 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4921 if (new_val != NULL)
4922 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4923 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4927 /* Nothing changed. */
4928 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4929 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4934 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4935 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4936 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4937 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4938 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4939 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4940 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4941 the first value assigned). */
4942 /* We print all the stop information in
4943 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4944 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4945 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4948 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4950 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4952 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4954 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4955 uiout->text ("\nWatchpoint ");
4956 uiout->field_int ("wpnum", b->number);
4957 uiout->text (" deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
4958 "which its expression is valid.\n");
4961 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4963 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4969 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
4970 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
4971 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
4974 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
4975 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
4976 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4978 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
4980 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
4981 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4983 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
4986 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
4987 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
4990 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
4992 const struct bp_location *bl;
4993 struct watchpoint *b;
4995 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4996 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
4997 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
4998 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4999 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5002 int must_check_value = 0;
5004 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5005 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5007 must_check_value = 1;
5008 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5009 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5010 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5012 must_check_value = 1;
5013 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5014 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5015 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5016 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5017 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5018 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5019 must_check_value = 1;
5021 if (must_check_value)
5027 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5029 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5031 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5032 "Error evaluating expression "
5033 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5036 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5038 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5041 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5049 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5050 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5054 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5057 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5058 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5060 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5062 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5063 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5064 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5065 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5066 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5067 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5068 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5071 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5072 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5075 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5076 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5077 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5078 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5080 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5081 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5082 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5085 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5086 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5087 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5088 changes. This still gives false positives when
5089 the program writes the same value to memory as
5090 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5091 it for a read), but it's much better than
5094 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5096 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5098 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5100 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5101 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5102 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5104 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5105 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5107 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5108 == watch_triggered_yes)
5110 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5116 if (other_write_watchpoint
5117 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5119 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5120 and the value changed since the last time we
5121 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5123 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5128 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5129 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5130 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5132 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5133 the value hasn't changed. */
5134 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5144 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5146 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5147 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5148 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5149 anything for this watchpoint. */
5150 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5156 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5157 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5158 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5159 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5162 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
5164 const struct bp_location *bl;
5165 struct breakpoint *b;
5167 bool condition_result = true;
5168 struct expression *cond;
5170 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5172 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5173 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5174 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5175 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5176 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5178 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5179 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5180 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5182 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5183 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5189 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5190 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5192 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5193 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5199 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5201 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5203 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5205 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5207 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5210 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5212 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5214 int within_current_scope = 1;
5215 struct watchpoint * w;
5217 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5218 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5219 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5220 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5222 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5224 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5225 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5229 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5230 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5231 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5232 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5233 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5235 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5236 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5239 struct frame_info *frame;
5241 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5242 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5243 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5244 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5245 really matter which instantiation of the function
5246 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5247 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5248 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5249 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5250 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5251 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5252 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5253 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5255 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5257 select_frame (frame);
5259 within_current_scope = 0;
5261 if (within_current_scope)
5265 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5267 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5269 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5270 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5276 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5277 "in the current scope"));
5278 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5279 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5281 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5282 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5285 if (cond && !condition_result)
5289 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5293 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5295 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5299 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5300 on the current target. */
5303 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5305 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5306 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5307 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5308 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5311 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5314 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5315 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5317 struct breakpoint *b;
5318 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5322 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5325 for (bp_location *bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5327 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5328 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5329 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5330 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5331 checked all locations already. */
5332 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5335 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5338 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5341 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5344 bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5347 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5348 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5349 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5353 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5354 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5355 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5357 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5359 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5361 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5366 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5367 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5368 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5370 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
5372 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5373 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5375 bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5376 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5379 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5387 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5390 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5391 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5392 const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
5395 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5396 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5397 bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
5399 int need_remove_insert;
5402 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5403 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5404 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5405 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5406 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5407 inferior function calls. */
5408 if (bs_head == NULL)
5409 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5411 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5412 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5413 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5415 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5417 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5419 handle_solib_event ();
5424 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5425 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5426 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5430 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5435 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5436 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5439 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5444 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5446 /* We will stop here. */
5447 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5449 --(b->enable_count);
5450 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5451 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5456 bs->commands = b->commands;
5457 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5458 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5461 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5466 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5468 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5469 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5472 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5473 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5474 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5476 need_remove_insert = 0;
5477 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5478 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5480 && bs->breakpoint_at
5481 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5483 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5485 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5486 need_remove_insert = 1;
5489 if (need_remove_insert)
5490 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5491 else if (removed_any)
5492 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5498 handle_jit_event (void)
5500 struct frame_info *frame;
5501 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5504 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5506 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5507 breakpoint_re_set. */
5508 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5510 frame = get_current_frame ();
5511 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5513 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5515 target_terminal::inferior ();
5518 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5520 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5523 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5525 struct bpstat_what retval;
5528 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5529 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5530 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5532 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5534 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5535 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5536 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5539 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5541 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5542 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5546 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5553 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5554 case bp_single_step:
5557 case bp_shlib_event:
5561 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5563 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5566 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5569 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5570 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5571 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5575 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5577 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5581 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5582 This requires no further action. */
5586 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5590 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5591 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5594 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5596 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5597 case bp_exception_resume:
5600 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5601 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5604 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5606 case bp_step_resume:
5608 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5611 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5612 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5615 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5617 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5620 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5621 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5624 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5625 case bp_thread_event:
5626 case bp_overlay_event:
5627 case bp_longjmp_master:
5628 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5629 case bp_exception_master:
5630 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5636 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5638 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5642 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5643 This requires no further action. */
5647 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5650 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5651 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5652 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5653 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5655 case bp_std_terminate:
5656 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5657 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5658 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5659 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5662 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5663 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5664 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5665 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5667 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5668 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5670 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5671 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5672 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5674 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5675 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5676 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5677 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5682 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5684 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5688 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5689 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5692 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5699 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5703 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5705 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5712 handle_jit_event ();
5714 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5715 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5717 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5718 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5724 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5725 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5726 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5729 bpstat_should_step (void)
5731 struct breakpoint *b;
5734 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5740 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5742 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5751 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5752 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5753 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5756 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5758 static char wrap_indent[80];
5759 int i, total_width, width, align;
5763 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5765 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5767 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5768 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5769 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5774 total_width += width + 1;
5780 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5781 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5783 "host": Host evals condition.
5784 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5785 "target": Target evals condition.
5789 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5791 struct bp_location *bl;
5792 char host_evals = 0;
5793 char target_evals = 0;
5798 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5801 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5802 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5803 return condition_evaluation_host;
5805 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5807 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5813 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5814 return condition_evaluation_both;
5815 else if (target_evals)
5816 return condition_evaluation_target;
5818 return condition_evaluation_host;
5821 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5822 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5825 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5827 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5830 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5831 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5832 return condition_evaluation_host;
5834 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5835 return condition_evaluation_target;
5837 return condition_evaluation_host;
5840 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5843 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5844 struct bp_location *loc)
5846 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5848 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5850 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5854 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5856 if (b->display_canonical)
5857 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5858 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5860 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5864 uiout->text ("in ");
5865 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
5867 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5868 uiout->text ("at ");
5870 uiout->field_string ("file",
5871 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
5874 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5875 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5877 uiout->field_int ("line", loc->line_number);
5883 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5885 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5889 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5890 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5891 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5892 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5893 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5894 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5896 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5900 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5904 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5905 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5906 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5909 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5910 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5916 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5918 struct ep_type_description
5921 const char *description;
5923 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5925 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5926 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5927 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5928 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5929 {bp_until, "until"},
5930 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5931 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5932 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5933 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5934 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5935 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5936 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5937 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5938 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5939 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5940 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5941 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5942 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5943 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5944 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5945 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5946 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5947 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5948 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5949 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5950 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5951 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5952 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
5953 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
5954 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
5955 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
5956 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
5957 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
5958 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
5961 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
5962 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
5963 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5964 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
5967 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
5970 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
5971 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
5974 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
5975 const char *field_name,
5976 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
5979 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
5981 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
5982 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
5983 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
5986 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
5988 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
5994 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
5995 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
6000 uiout->text (" inf ");
6004 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
6009 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6012 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6013 struct bp_location *loc,
6015 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6018 struct command_line *l;
6019 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6021 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6022 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6023 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6024 struct value_print_options opts;
6026 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6028 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6029 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6030 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6033 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6034 header_of_multiple = 1;
6042 if (part_of_multiple)
6043 uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6045 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
6049 if (part_of_multiple)
6050 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6052 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6056 if (part_of_multiple)
6057 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6059 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6064 if (part_of_multiple)
6065 uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6067 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6072 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6074 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6075 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6076 make sure there's just one location. */
6077 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6078 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6084 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6085 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6089 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6090 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6091 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6093 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6095 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6096 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6097 is relatively readable). */
6098 if (opts.addressprint)
6099 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6101 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6106 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6107 case bp_single_step:
6111 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6112 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6114 case bp_exception_resume:
6115 case bp_step_resume:
6116 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6117 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6119 case bp_std_terminate:
6120 case bp_shlib_event:
6121 case bp_thread_event:
6122 case bp_overlay_event:
6123 case bp_longjmp_master:
6124 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6125 case bp_exception_master:
6127 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6128 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6131 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6132 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6133 if (opts.addressprint)
6136 if (header_of_multiple)
6137 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6138 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6139 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>");
6141 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6142 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6145 if (!header_of_multiple)
6146 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6153 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6155 struct inferior *inf;
6156 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6161 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6162 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6165 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6166 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6168 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6169 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6170 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6171 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6172 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6173 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6175 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6178 if (!part_of_multiple)
6180 if (b->thread != -1)
6182 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6183 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6184 uiout->text (" thread ");
6185 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6187 else if (b->task != 0)
6189 uiout->text (" task ");
6190 uiout->field_int ("task", b->task);
6196 if (!part_of_multiple)
6197 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6199 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6202 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6203 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6205 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6206 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6210 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6213 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6214 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6216 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6217 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6219 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6220 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6221 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6222 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6223 == condition_evaluation_target)
6226 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
6227 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6228 uiout->text (" evals)");
6233 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6235 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6236 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6237 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6238 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6241 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6243 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6248 if (!part_of_multiple)
6252 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6253 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6254 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6255 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6256 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6258 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6259 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6260 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6261 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6262 uiout->text (" time\n");
6264 uiout->text (" times\n");
6268 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6269 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6270 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6274 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6277 uiout->text ("\tignore next ");
6278 uiout->field_int ("ignore", b->ignore_count);
6279 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6282 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6283 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6284 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6285 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6288 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6289 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6290 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6291 if (b->ignore_count)
6292 uiout->text ("additional ");
6294 uiout->text ("next ");
6295 uiout->field_int ("enable", b->enable_count);
6296 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6299 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6301 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6303 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6305 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6306 uiout->field_int ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6307 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6311 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6312 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6315 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6316 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6319 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6321 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6323 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6325 annotate_field (10);
6326 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6327 uiout->field_int ("pass", t->pass_count);
6328 uiout->text (" \n");
6331 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6333 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6335 annotate_field (11);
6337 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6338 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6339 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6345 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6346 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6351 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6353 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6355 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6357 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6359 else if (b->location != NULL
6360 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6361 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6362 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6367 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6368 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6371 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6374 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "bkpt");
6376 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6379 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6380 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6381 locations, if any. */
6382 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6384 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6385 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6386 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6389 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6390 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6392 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6393 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6395 struct bp_location *loc;
6398 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6400 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6401 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6408 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6410 int print_address_bits = 0;
6411 struct bp_location *loc;
6413 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6414 address to print. */
6415 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6418 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6422 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6423 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6424 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6427 return print_address_bits;
6430 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6433 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6435 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6436 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6439 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6440 internal or momentary. */
6443 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6445 return b->number > 0;
6448 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6451 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6453 return b->loc == NULL;
6456 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6457 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6458 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6459 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6460 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6461 breakpoints listed. */
6464 breakpoint_1 (const char *args, int allflag,
6465 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6467 struct breakpoint *b;
6468 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6469 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6470 struct value_print_options opts;
6471 int print_address_bits = 0;
6472 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6473 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6475 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6477 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6478 required for address fields. */
6479 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6482 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6483 if (filter && !filter (b))
6486 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6487 accept. Skip the others. */
6488 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6490 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6492 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6496 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6498 int addr_bit, type_len;
6500 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6501 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6502 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6504 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6505 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6506 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6508 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6513 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6514 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6515 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6518 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6519 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6520 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6522 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6523 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6525 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6526 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6528 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6529 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6531 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6532 if (opts.addressprint)
6534 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6536 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6537 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6539 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6541 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6543 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6544 uiout->table_body ();
6545 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6546 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6551 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6552 if (filter && !filter (b))
6555 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6556 accept. Skip the others. */
6558 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6560 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6562 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6565 else /* all others */
6567 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6571 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6573 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6574 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6578 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6580 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6584 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6585 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6587 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6593 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6594 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6597 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6598 there have been breakpoints? */
6599 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6601 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6604 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6605 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6608 default_collect_info (void)
6610 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6612 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6613 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6615 if (!*default_collect)
6618 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6620 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6621 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6622 uiout->text (" \n");
6626 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6628 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6630 default_collect_info ();
6634 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6636 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6637 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6639 if (num_printed == 0)
6641 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6642 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6644 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6649 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6651 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6653 default_collect_info ();
6657 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6658 struct program_space *pspace,
6659 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6661 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6663 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6665 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6666 && bl->address == pc
6667 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6673 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6674 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6678 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6679 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6680 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6683 struct breakpoint *b;
6686 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6687 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6691 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6692 else /* if (others == ???) */
6693 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6695 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6698 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6699 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6700 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6701 else if (b->thread != -1)
6702 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6703 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6704 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6705 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6709 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6711 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6712 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6713 printf_filtered (".\n");
6718 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6719 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6720 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6721 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6723 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6724 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6725 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6726 breakpoint location at address zero:
6734 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6736 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6738 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6741 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6742 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6745 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6746 struct bp_location *loc2)
6748 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6749 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6751 /* Both of them must exist. */
6752 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6753 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6755 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6756 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6757 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6758 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6759 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6760 other watchpoint. */
6762 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6764 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6765 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6767 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6769 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6770 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6773 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6774 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6775 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6776 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6777 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6778 become hw_access locations later. */
6779 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6780 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6781 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6782 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6785 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6788 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6789 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6791 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6792 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6796 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6797 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6798 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6799 space doesn't really matter. */
6802 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6804 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6807 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6808 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6809 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6812 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6813 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6814 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6815 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6818 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6819 const address_space *aspace,
6822 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6825 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6826 bl->address, bl->length,
6830 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6831 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6832 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6833 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6834 doesn't really matter. */
6837 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6838 const address_space *aspace,
6839 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6841 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6842 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6844 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6846 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6852 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6853 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6854 true, otherwise returns false. */
6857 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6858 struct bp_location *loc2)
6860 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6861 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6862 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6863 different locations. */
6864 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6869 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6870 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6871 represent the same location. */
6874 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6875 struct bp_location *loc2)
6877 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6879 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6880 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6881 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6883 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6884 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6886 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6889 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6890 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6891 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6893 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6894 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6895 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6896 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6900 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6901 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6903 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6904 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6908 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6909 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6911 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6912 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6914 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6917 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6918 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6919 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6920 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6923 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6924 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6926 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6927 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6928 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6929 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6930 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6932 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6933 have their addresses modified. */
6936 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6938 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6939 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6940 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6941 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6942 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6943 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6948 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
6950 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
6952 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
6953 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
6954 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
6957 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
6959 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
6960 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
6962 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
6963 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
6965 return adjusted_bpaddr;
6969 bp_location::bp_location (const bp_location_ops *ops, breakpoint *owner)
6971 bp_location *loc = this;
6973 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
6977 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
6978 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
6981 switch (owner->type)
6984 case bp_single_step:
6988 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6989 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6991 case bp_exception_resume:
6992 case bp_step_resume:
6993 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6994 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6996 case bp_std_terminate:
6997 case bp_shlib_event:
6998 case bp_thread_event:
6999 case bp_overlay_event:
7001 case bp_longjmp_master:
7002 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7003 case bp_exception_master:
7004 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7005 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7007 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7008 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7010 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7011 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7012 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7014 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7015 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7016 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7017 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7022 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7023 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7024 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7027 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7033 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7035 static struct bp_location *
7036 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7038 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7042 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7044 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7048 /* Increment reference count. */
7051 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7056 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7057 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7060 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7062 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7064 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7065 free_bp_location (*blp);
7069 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7072 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7074 struct breakpoint *b1;
7075 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7077 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7078 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7080 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7082 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7087 b1->next = b.release ();
7093 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7096 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7097 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7099 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7101 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7105 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7106 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7107 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7108 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7111 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7112 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7114 static struct breakpoint *
7115 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7117 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7119 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7121 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7122 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7125 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7126 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7130 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7132 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7134 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7135 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7136 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7138 const char *function_name;
7140 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7141 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7142 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc)
7145 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7147 function_name = MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (loc->msymbol);
7149 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7150 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7152 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7153 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7154 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7155 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7157 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7161 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7164 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7168 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7170 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7173 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7175 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7180 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7181 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7182 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7184 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7185 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7186 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7189 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7190 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7191 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7193 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7195 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7197 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7198 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7200 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7201 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7203 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7204 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7207 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7208 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7209 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7210 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7211 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7212 is also returned as the value of this function.
7214 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7215 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7216 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7217 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7218 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7219 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7220 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7223 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7224 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7225 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7227 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7229 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7230 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7233 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7234 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7235 initiated the operation. */
7238 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7240 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7241 int thread = tp->global_num;
7243 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7244 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7245 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7246 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7247 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7248 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7249 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7250 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7252 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7253 struct breakpoint *clone;
7255 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7256 after their removal. */
7257 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7258 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7259 clone->thread = thread;
7262 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7265 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7267 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7269 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7271 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7272 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7274 if (b->thread == thread)
7275 delete_breakpoint (b);
7280 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7282 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7284 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7285 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7287 if (b->thread == thread)
7288 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7292 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7293 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7294 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7298 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7300 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7303 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7305 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7307 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7308 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7310 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7312 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7314 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7317 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7318 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7319 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7320 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7326 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7327 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7330 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7331 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7335 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7337 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7339 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7340 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7342 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7344 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7345 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7346 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7347 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7350 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7352 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7354 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7355 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7356 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7358 delete_breakpoint (b);
7363 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7365 struct breakpoint *b;
7368 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7370 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7371 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7372 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7377 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7379 struct breakpoint *b;
7382 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7384 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7385 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7386 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7390 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7391 master breakpoint. */
7393 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7395 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7397 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7398 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7399 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7401 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7402 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7406 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7408 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7410 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7412 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7413 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7414 delete_breakpoint (b);
7418 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7420 struct breakpoint *b;
7422 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7423 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7425 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7426 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7427 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7429 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7434 struct lang_and_radix
7440 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7443 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7445 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7446 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7449 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7452 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7454 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7456 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7457 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7458 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7459 delete_breakpoint (b);
7463 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7465 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7467 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7468 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7469 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7470 delete_breakpoint (b);
7473 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7476 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7478 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7480 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7481 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7482 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7483 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7486 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7487 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7488 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7490 static struct breakpoint *
7491 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7492 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7494 struct breakpoint *b;
7496 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7497 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7498 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7503 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7505 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7508 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7511 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7513 struct breakpoint *b;
7515 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7517 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7518 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7520 delete_breakpoint (b);
7526 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7527 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7530 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7532 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7534 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7536 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7537 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7539 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7540 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7541 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7542 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7543 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7544 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7545 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7546 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7547 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7548 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7549 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7550 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7553 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7558 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7559 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7560 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7563 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7565 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7566 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7568 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7570 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7571 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7573 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7574 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7575 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7576 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7577 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7578 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7579 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7580 || is_tracepoint (b))
7581 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7583 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7584 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7585 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7586 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7589 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7590 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7592 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7594 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7595 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7596 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7599 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7604 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7605 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7606 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7609 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7611 struct breakpoint *b;
7613 if (objfile == NULL)
7616 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7617 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7618 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7619 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7620 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7621 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7622 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7623 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7624 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7625 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7627 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7628 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7633 struct bp_location *loc;
7634 int bp_modified = 0;
7636 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7639 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7641 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7643 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7644 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7647 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7650 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7653 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7654 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7657 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7659 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7660 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7661 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7662 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7663 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7666 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7673 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7677 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7679 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7680 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7681 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7683 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7685 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7686 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7687 catchpoint has triggered. */
7688 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7691 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7695 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7697 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7700 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7704 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7706 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7709 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7713 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7714 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7715 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7717 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7719 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7722 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7726 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7729 static enum print_stop_action
7730 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7732 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7733 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7734 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7736 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7737 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7738 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7739 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7741 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7742 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7744 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7745 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7747 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7748 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7749 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7750 uiout->text ("), ");
7751 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7754 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7758 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7760 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7761 struct value_print_options opts;
7762 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7764 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7766 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7767 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7769 if (opts.addressprint)
7770 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7772 uiout->text ("fork");
7773 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7775 uiout->text (", process ");
7776 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7780 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7781 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7784 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7788 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7790 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7793 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7797 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7799 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7800 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7803 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7805 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7807 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7811 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7813 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7816 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7820 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7822 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7825 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7829 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7830 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7831 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7833 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7835 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7838 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7842 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7845 static enum print_stop_action
7846 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7848 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7849 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7850 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7852 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7853 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7854 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7855 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7857 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7858 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7860 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7861 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7863 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7864 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7865 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7866 uiout->text ("), ");
7867 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7870 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7874 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7876 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7877 struct value_print_options opts;
7878 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7880 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7881 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7882 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7884 if (opts.addressprint)
7885 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7887 uiout->text ("vfork");
7888 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7890 uiout->text (", process ");
7891 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7895 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7896 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7899 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7903 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7905 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7908 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7912 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7914 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7915 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7918 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7920 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7922 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7923 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7924 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7926 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7928 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7930 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7931 unsigned char is_load;
7933 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7934 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7936 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7939 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7941 xfree (this->regex);
7945 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7951 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7957 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
7958 const address_space *aspace,
7960 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7962 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7963 struct breakpoint *other;
7965 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
7968 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
7970 struct bp_location *other_bl;
7972 if (other == bl->owner)
7975 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
7978 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
7981 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
7983 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
7992 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
7994 struct solib_catchpoint *self
7995 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7999 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
8002 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8008 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
8011 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8017 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8020 static enum print_stop_action
8021 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8023 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8024 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8026 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8027 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8028 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8029 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8031 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8032 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8034 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8035 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8036 print_solib_event (1);
8037 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8041 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8043 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8044 struct value_print_options opts;
8045 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8047 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8048 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8049 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8051 if (opts.addressprint)
8054 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8062 msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8064 msg = _("load of library");
8069 msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8071 msg = _("unload of library");
8073 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8075 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8076 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8080 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8082 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8084 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8085 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8089 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8091 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8093 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8094 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8095 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8097 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8098 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8101 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8103 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8104 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8105 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8106 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8107 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8108 created in an enabled state. */
8111 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8113 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8117 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8119 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8123 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8124 _("Invalid regexp")));
8125 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8128 c->is_load = is_load;
8129 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8130 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8132 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8134 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8137 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8141 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8142 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8145 const int enabled = 1;
8147 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8149 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8153 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8154 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8156 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8160 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8161 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8163 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8166 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8167 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8168 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8169 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8172 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8173 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8174 const char *cond_string,
8175 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8177 symtab_and_line sal;
8178 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8180 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8182 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8183 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8187 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8189 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8190 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8191 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8192 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8195 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
8198 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8202 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8203 int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
8204 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8206 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8208 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8210 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8212 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8215 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8217 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8218 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8219 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8221 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8223 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8225 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8226 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8228 char *exec_pathname;
8231 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8233 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8235 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8239 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8241 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8245 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8247 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8251 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8252 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8253 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8255 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8257 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8260 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8264 static enum print_stop_action
8265 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8267 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8268 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8269 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8271 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8272 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8273 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8274 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8276 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8277 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8279 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8280 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8282 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8283 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8284 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8285 uiout->text ("), ");
8287 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8291 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8293 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8294 struct value_print_options opts;
8295 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8297 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8299 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8300 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8301 is relatively readable). */
8302 if (opts.addressprint)
8303 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8305 uiout->text ("exec");
8306 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8308 uiout->text (", program \"");
8309 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8310 uiout->text ("\" ");
8313 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8314 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8318 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8320 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8323 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8327 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8329 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8330 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8333 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8336 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8339 struct breakpoint *b;
8340 struct bp_location *bl;
8344 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8345 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8347 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8349 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8356 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8360 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8363 struct bp_location *bl;
8365 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8368 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8370 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8372 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8378 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8379 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8380 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8381 types _not_ TYPE. */
8384 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8385 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8388 struct breakpoint *b;
8390 *other_type_used = 0;
8395 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8398 if (b->type == type)
8399 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8400 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8401 *other_type_used = 1;
8408 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8410 struct breakpoint *b;
8414 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8416 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8417 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8423 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8425 struct breakpoint *b;
8429 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8431 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8432 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8438 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8440 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8441 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8445 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8447 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8448 breakpoint_re_set ();
8451 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8454 static struct breakpoint *
8455 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8457 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8459 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8460 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8462 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8463 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8466 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8468 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8471 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8472 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8476 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8477 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8479 struct breakpoint *b;
8481 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8483 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8485 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8486 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8487 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8488 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8490 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8492 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8494 return breakpoint_up (b);
8497 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8498 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8499 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8501 static struct breakpoint *
8502 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8504 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8507 struct breakpoint *copy;
8509 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8510 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8511 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8513 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8514 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8515 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8516 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8517 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8518 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8519 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8520 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8521 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8522 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8523 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8524 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8526 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8527 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8528 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8530 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8534 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8538 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8540 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8544 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8548 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8551 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8553 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8555 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8556 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8558 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8562 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8565 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8567 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8568 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8572 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8574 static struct bp_location *
8575 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8576 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8578 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8579 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8580 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8582 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8583 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8585 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8586 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8587 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8588 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8589 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8590 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8591 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8594 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8595 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8596 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8597 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8602 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8603 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8604 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8605 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8606 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8607 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8608 loc->section = sal->section;
8609 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8610 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8611 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8612 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8613 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8614 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8616 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8617 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8619 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8620 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8621 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8622 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8623 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8624 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8625 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8626 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8627 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8628 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8629 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8630 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8632 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8639 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8642 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8646 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8647 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8650 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8652 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8656 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
8658 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8659 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8660 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8661 scoped_restore restore_memory
8662 = make_scoped_restore_show_memory_breakpoints (0);
8664 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8665 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8671 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8672 return 0 otherwise. */
8675 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8677 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8679 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
8680 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
8681 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8683 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
8686 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8687 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8688 return program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8691 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8692 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8695 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8697 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8698 char *printf_line = NULL;
8703 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8705 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8707 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8709 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8711 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8712 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8714 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8715 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8716 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8718 if (!dprintf_function)
8719 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8721 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8722 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8727 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8731 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8733 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8734 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8737 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8738 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8742 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8743 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8745 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8747 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8748 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8749 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
8750 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8751 command_lines_deleter ()));
8754 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8755 current style settings. */
8758 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8759 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8761 struct breakpoint *b;
8765 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8766 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8770 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8771 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8772 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8773 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8776 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8777 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8778 event_location_up &&location,
8779 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8780 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8781 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8782 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8783 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8784 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8785 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8786 int display_canonical)
8790 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8792 int target_resources_ok;
8794 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8795 target_resources_ok =
8796 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8798 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8799 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8800 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8801 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8804 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8806 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8808 struct bp_location *loc;
8812 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8814 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8816 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8817 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8820 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8822 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8826 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8827 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8828 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8829 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8830 b->disposition = disposition;
8832 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8833 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8835 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8837 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8838 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8840 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8842 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8843 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8845 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8848 p = skip_spaces (p);
8850 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8852 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8854 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8856 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8858 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8860 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8862 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8864 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8867 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8868 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8875 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8876 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8882 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
8884 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
8885 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
8887 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
8890 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8891 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8892 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8894 if (b->extra_string)
8895 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8897 error (_("Format string required"));
8899 else if (b->extra_string)
8900 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8903 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8904 if (location != NULL)
8905 b->location = std::move (location);
8907 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8908 b->filter = filter.release ();
8912 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8913 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8914 event_location_up &&location,
8915 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8916 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8917 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8918 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8919 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8920 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8921 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8922 int display_canonical)
8924 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8926 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8927 sals, std::move (location),
8929 std::move (cond_string),
8930 std::move (extra_string),
8932 thread, task, ignore_count,
8934 enabled, internal, flags,
8937 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
8940 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8941 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8942 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8943 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8944 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8945 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8946 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8947 we take just a single condition string.
8949 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8950 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8951 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8952 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8953 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8956 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8957 struct linespec_result *canonical,
8958 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8959 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8960 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8961 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8962 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8963 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
8965 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
8966 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
8968 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
8970 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8971 'break', without arguments. */
8972 event_location_up location
8973 = (canonical->location != NULL
8974 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
8975 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
8976 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
8978 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
8979 std::move (location),
8980 std::move (filter_string),
8981 std::move (cond_string),
8982 std::move (extra_string),
8984 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
8985 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
8986 canonical->special_display);
8990 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
8991 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
8992 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
8993 linespec locations).
8995 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
8996 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
8999 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
9000 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9002 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9004 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9006 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9010 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9011 breakpoint address. */
9012 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9014 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9015 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9016 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9017 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9018 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9019 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9020 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9022 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9024 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9025 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9026 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9027 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9028 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9030 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9032 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9034 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9036 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9040 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9044 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9045 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9046 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9047 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9049 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9050 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9051 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9052 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9054 const char *spec = NULL;
9056 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9057 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9061 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
9064 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9065 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9066 get_last_displayed_line (),
9067 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9072 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9073 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9077 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9078 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9081 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9083 for (auto &sal : sals)
9084 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9087 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9088 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9089 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9090 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9091 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9095 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9096 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9098 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9100 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9102 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9103 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9104 associated with SAL. */
9108 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9109 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9110 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9114 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9115 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9116 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9117 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9118 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9119 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9122 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9123 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9126 *cond_string = NULL;
9133 const char *end_tok;
9135 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9136 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9138 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9140 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9142 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9146 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9148 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9150 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9152 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9153 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9155 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9157 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9160 struct thread_info *thr;
9163 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9165 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9166 *thread = thr->global_num;
9169 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9174 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9176 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9177 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9178 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9183 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9187 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9191 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9193 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9194 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9196 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9199 p = skip_spaces (p);
9201 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9203 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9205 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
9206 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9207 if (markers.empty ())
9208 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9209 marker_str.c_str ());
9211 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9212 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
9214 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
9216 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
9217 sal.pc = marker.address;
9218 sals.push_back (sal);
9225 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9228 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9229 const struct event_location *location,
9230 const char *cond_string,
9231 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9233 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9235 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9236 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9237 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9240 struct linespec_result canonical;
9241 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9244 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9246 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9248 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9249 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9250 extra_string = NULL;
9254 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9256 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9258 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9260 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9262 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9265 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9266 throw_exception (e);
9268 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9270 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9271 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9272 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9273 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9274 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9277 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9278 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9279 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9280 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9284 throw_exception (e);
9288 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9291 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9292 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9293 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9294 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9295 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9297 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9298 are ok for the target. */
9301 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9302 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9305 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9306 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9308 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9309 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9312 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9313 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9317 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9318 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9325 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9327 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9328 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9329 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9330 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9332 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
9333 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9334 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9335 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9339 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9340 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9341 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9343 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9345 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9346 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9348 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9351 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9352 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9353 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9355 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9356 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9357 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9361 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9363 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9364 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9367 b->cond_string = NULL;
9370 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9371 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9375 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9376 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9377 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9378 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9379 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9380 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9381 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9382 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9383 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9385 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9388 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9390 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9391 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9392 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9395 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9397 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9399 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9400 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9405 /* Set a breakpoint.
9406 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9407 condition, and thread.
9408 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9409 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9413 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9415 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9416 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9417 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9419 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9421 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9423 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9424 if (location != NULL
9425 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9426 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9428 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9430 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9432 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9433 tempflag, type_wanted,
9434 0 /* Ignore count */,
9435 pending_break_support,
9443 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9446 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9450 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9452 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9453 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9454 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9457 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9458 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9459 if (sal->explicit_line)
9460 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9463 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9465 const struct blockvector *bv;
9466 const struct block *b;
9469 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9470 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9473 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9476 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9477 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9482 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9483 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9484 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9485 happen in assembly source). */
9487 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9488 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9490 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9492 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9499 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9501 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9505 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9507 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9511 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9513 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9517 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9519 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9523 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9525 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9526 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9527 stop at <line>\n"));
9531 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9535 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9537 else if (*arg != '*')
9539 const char *argptr = arg;
9542 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9543 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9544 function/method name. */
9545 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9547 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9552 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9554 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9558 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9560 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9564 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9568 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9572 const char *argptr = arg;
9575 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9576 it is probably a line number. */
9577 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9579 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9584 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9586 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9590 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
9592 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9595 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9596 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9597 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9601 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9603 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9605 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9606 the next character must be ','. */
9609 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9610 error (_("Format string required"));
9613 /* Skip the comma. */
9618 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9620 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9622 0 /* Ignore count */,
9623 pending_break_support,
9624 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9632 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9634 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9637 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9638 ranged breakpoints. */
9641 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9642 const address_space *aspace,
9644 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9646 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9647 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9650 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9651 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9654 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9655 ranged breakpoints. */
9658 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9660 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9663 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9664 ranged breakpoints. */
9666 static enum print_stop_action
9667 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9669 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9670 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9671 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9673 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9675 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9676 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9678 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9680 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9682 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9683 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9685 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9686 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9688 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9689 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9690 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9692 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
9695 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9698 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9699 ranged breakpoints. */
9702 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9703 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9705 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9706 struct value_print_options opts;
9707 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9709 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9710 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9712 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9714 if (opts.addressprint)
9715 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9716 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9717 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9719 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9723 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9724 ranged breakpoints. */
9727 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9728 struct ui_out *uiout)
9730 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9731 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9736 address_start = bl->address;
9737 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9739 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9740 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9741 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9742 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9743 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9747 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9748 ranged breakpoints. */
9751 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9753 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9754 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9757 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9759 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9760 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9761 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9764 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9765 ranged breakpoints. */
9768 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9770 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9771 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9772 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9773 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9776 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9778 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9780 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9781 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9782 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9783 last instruction of the given line. */
9786 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9790 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9791 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9792 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9799 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9801 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9803 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9810 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9813 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9815 const char *arg_start;
9816 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9817 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9819 struct breakpoint *b;
9821 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9822 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9823 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9825 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9826 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9827 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9830 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9832 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9833 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9834 error(_("No address range specified."));
9837 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9839 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9842 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9843 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9844 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9846 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9848 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9849 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9850 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9852 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9853 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9855 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9856 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9858 /* Parse the end location. */
9862 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9863 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9864 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9865 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9866 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9867 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9869 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9870 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9871 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9873 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
9874 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9876 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
9877 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
9878 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
9879 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9881 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
9883 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9884 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9885 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9887 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9889 /* Length overflowed. */
9890 error (_("Address range too large."));
9891 else if (length == 1)
9893 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9894 the `hbreak' command. */
9895 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
9900 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9901 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9902 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9903 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9904 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9905 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9906 b->location = std::move (start_location);
9907 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
9908 b->loc->length = length;
9911 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
9912 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9915 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9916 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9917 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9921 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
9929 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
9930 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
9933 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
9943 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9944 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9945 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9946 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9947 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9949 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9975 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
9978 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9979 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
9984 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
9985 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
9986 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
9987 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
9988 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
9989 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
9990 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
9992 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
9993 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
9998 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10000 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10001 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10002 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10003 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10005 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10006 are always constant. */
10008 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10010 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10011 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10012 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10017 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10018 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10019 then it is not a constant. */
10028 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10030 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10032 xfree (this->exp_string);
10033 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10036 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10039 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10041 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10043 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10044 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10046 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10047 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10048 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10049 are loaded and unloaded.
10051 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10052 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10053 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10054 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10055 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10056 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10058 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10059 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10060 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10061 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10063 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10064 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10066 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10067 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10068 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10071 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10074 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10076 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10077 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10079 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10080 w->cond_exp.get ());
10083 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10086 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10088 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10089 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10091 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10092 w->cond_exp.get ());
10096 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10097 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10098 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10100 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10101 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10103 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10104 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10105 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10106 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10107 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10108 (did not match the data address). */
10109 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10110 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10117 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10119 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10121 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10124 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10125 hardware watchpoints. */
10128 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10130 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10131 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10133 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10136 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10137 hardware watchpoints. */
10140 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10142 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10143 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10146 static enum print_stop_action
10147 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10149 struct breakpoint *b;
10150 enum print_stop_action result;
10151 struct watchpoint *w;
10152 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10154 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10156 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10157 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10159 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10160 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10164 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10167 case bp_watchpoint:
10168 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10169 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10170 uiout->field_string
10171 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10173 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10174 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10175 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10176 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10177 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10178 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10179 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10180 uiout->text ("\n");
10181 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10182 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10185 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10186 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10187 uiout->field_string
10188 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10190 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10191 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10192 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10193 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10194 uiout->text ("\n");
10195 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10198 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10199 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10201 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10202 uiout->field_string
10204 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10206 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10207 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10208 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10209 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10210 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10215 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10216 uiout->field_string
10218 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10219 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10220 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10222 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10223 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10224 uiout->text ("\n");
10225 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10228 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10234 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10238 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10240 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10241 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10242 const char *tuple_name;
10246 case bp_watchpoint:
10247 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10248 tuple_name = "wpt";
10250 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10251 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10252 tuple_name = "wpt";
10254 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10255 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10256 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10258 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10259 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10260 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10263 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10264 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10267 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10268 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10269 uiout->text (": ");
10270 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10273 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10277 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10279 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10283 case bp_watchpoint:
10284 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10285 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10287 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10288 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10290 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10291 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10294 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10295 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10298 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10299 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10302 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10306 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10308 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10309 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10310 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10316 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10318 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10320 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10321 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10324 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10326 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10328 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10329 bl->watchpoint_type);
10332 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10333 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10336 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10338 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10340 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10341 bl->watchpoint_type);
10344 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10345 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10348 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10350 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10352 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10355 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10356 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10359 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10364 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10365 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10367 static enum print_stop_action
10368 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10370 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10371 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10373 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10374 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10376 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10377 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10381 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10382 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10383 uiout->field_string
10384 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10387 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10388 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10389 uiout->field_string
10390 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10393 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10394 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10395 uiout->field_string
10397 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10400 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10401 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10405 uiout->text (_("\n\
10406 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10407 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10408 uiout->text ("\n");
10410 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10411 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10414 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10415 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10418 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10419 struct ui_out *uiout)
10421 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10423 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10424 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10426 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10427 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10428 uiout->text ("\n");
10431 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10432 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10435 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10437 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10438 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10439 const char *tuple_name;
10443 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10444 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10445 tuple_name = "wpt";
10447 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10448 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10449 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10451 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10452 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10453 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10456 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10457 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10460 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10461 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10462 uiout->text (": ");
10463 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10466 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10467 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10470 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10472 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10477 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10478 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10480 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10481 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10483 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10484 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10487 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10488 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10491 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10492 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10493 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10496 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10498 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10500 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10503 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10505 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10508 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10509 hw_read: watch read,
10510 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10512 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10513 int just_location, int internal)
10515 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10516 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10517 struct value *result;
10518 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10519 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10520 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10521 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10523 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10524 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10525 enum bptype bp_type;
10528 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10529 the hardware watchpoint. */
10531 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10533 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10534 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10536 const char *value_start;
10538 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10540 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10541 of the arguments string. */
10542 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10544 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10545 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10548 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10549 This is the value of the parameter. */
10550 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10552 value_start = tok + 1;
10554 /* Skip whitespace. */
10555 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10560 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10561 This is the parameter itself. */
10562 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10565 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10567 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10569 struct thread_info *thr;
10570 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10571 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10572 only in a specific thread. */
10576 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10578 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10579 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10581 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10582 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10583 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10585 thread = thr->global_num;
10587 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10589 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10590 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10592 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10595 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10597 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10599 mark = value_mark ();
10600 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10601 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10602 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10605 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10608 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10609 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10616 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10617 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10619 innermost_block.reset ();
10620 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10621 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10622 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
10624 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10625 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10627 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10630 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10631 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10635 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10636 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10638 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10641 exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10642 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
10643 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10644 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10647 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10649 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10650 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10658 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10659 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10660 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10664 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10667 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10668 else if (ret == -2)
10669 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10672 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10673 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10675 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10676 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10678 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10679 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10681 innermost_block.reset ();
10682 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10683 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
10685 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10686 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10687 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10692 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10694 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10696 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10698 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10700 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10701 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10702 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10703 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10704 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10706 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10708 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10710 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10711 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10714 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10715 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10716 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10718 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10721 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10723 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10724 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10726 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10727 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10729 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10730 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10731 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10732 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10733 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10734 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10735 scope_breakpoint->type);
10739 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10740 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10741 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10742 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10744 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10745 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10746 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10747 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10749 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10751 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10754 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10755 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10757 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10758 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10759 w->thread = thread;
10760 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10761 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10762 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10763 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10764 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10767 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10768 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10770 w->exp_string_reparse
10771 = current_language->la_watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10773 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10774 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10777 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10781 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10786 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10787 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10792 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10794 w->cond_string = 0;
10796 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10798 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10799 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10803 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10804 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10807 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10809 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10810 need to act on them together. */
10811 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10812 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10815 if (!just_location)
10816 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10818 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10819 that should be inserted. */
10820 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10822 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10825 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10826 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10829 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10831 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10833 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10834 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10837 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10838 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10840 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10841 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10842 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10843 hardware watchpoint.
10845 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10846 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10847 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10848 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10849 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10850 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10851 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10852 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10853 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10855 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10856 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10857 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10858 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10859 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10861 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10863 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10865 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10866 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10867 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10868 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10869 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10870 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10874 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10875 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10876 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10878 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10879 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10880 middle of some value chain. */
10882 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10883 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10885 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10889 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10890 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10891 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10893 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10897 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10901 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10902 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10903 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10904 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10905 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10908 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10909 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10910 return found_memory_cnt;
10914 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10916 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10919 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10920 calls watch_command_1. */
10923 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
10925 int just_location = 0;
10928 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
10929 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
10931 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10935 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
10939 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10941 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
10945 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10947 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
10951 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10953 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
10957 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10959 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
10963 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10965 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
10969 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
10970 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
10973 struct until_break_fsm
10975 /* The base class. */
10976 struct thread_fsm thread_fsm;
10978 /* The thread that as current when the command was executed. */
10981 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
10982 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
10984 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
10986 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint;
10989 static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
10990 struct thread_info *thread);
10991 static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
10992 struct thread_info *thread);
10993 static enum async_reply_reason
10994 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self);
10996 /* until_break_fsm's vtable. */
10998 static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops =
11001 until_break_fsm_clean_up,
11002 until_break_fsm_should_stop,
11003 NULL, /* return_value */
11004 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason,
11007 /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm. */
11009 static struct until_break_fsm *
11010 new_until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11011 breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
11012 breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
11014 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11016 sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm);
11017 thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops, cmd_interp);
11019 sm->thread = thread;
11020 sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint.release ();
11021 sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint.release ();
11026 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11027 until(location)/advance commands. */
11030 until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11031 struct thread_info *tp)
11033 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11035 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11036 sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL
11037 || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL
11038 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11039 sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL))
11040 thread_fsm_set_finished (self);
11045 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11046 until(location)/advance commands. */
11049 until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11050 struct thread_info *thread)
11052 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11054 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11055 if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL)
11057 delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint);
11058 sm->location_breakpoint = NULL;
11060 if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL)
11062 delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint);
11063 sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11065 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread);
11068 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11069 until(location)/advance commands. */
11071 static enum async_reply_reason
11072 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self)
11074 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11078 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11080 struct frame_info *frame;
11081 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11082 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11083 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11084 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11086 struct thread_info *tp;
11087 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11089 clear_proceed_status (0);
11091 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11094 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11096 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11097 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11098 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11099 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11100 get_last_displayed_line ())
11101 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11102 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0));
11104 if (sals.size () != 1)
11105 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11107 symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
11110 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11112 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11114 tp = inferior_thread ();
11115 thread = tp->global_num;
11117 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11119 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11120 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11121 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11124 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11125 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11126 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11127 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11129 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11132 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
11133 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11135 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11136 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11138 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11139 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11140 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11141 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11146 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11147 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11150 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11153 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
11155 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11156 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11157 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11158 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11160 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11161 only at the very same frame. */
11162 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11163 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11165 sm = new_until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11166 std::move (location_breakpoint),
11167 std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11168 tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm;
11170 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11172 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11175 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11176 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11178 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11179 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11180 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11181 if clause in the arg string. */
11184 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11186 const char *cond_string;
11188 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11191 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11194 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11195 condition string. */
11196 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11197 cond_string = *arg;
11199 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11201 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11203 return cond_string;
11206 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11207 process start/exit, etc. */
11211 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11212 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11217 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11218 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11220 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11221 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11222 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11225 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11226 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11227 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11231 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11233 /* The allowed syntax is:
11235 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11237 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11238 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11240 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11241 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11243 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11244 and enable reporting of such events. */
11247 case catch_fork_temporary:
11248 case catch_fork_permanent:
11249 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11250 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11252 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11253 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11254 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11255 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11258 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11264 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11265 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11267 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11269 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11271 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11275 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11277 /* The allowed syntax is:
11279 catch exec if <cond>
11281 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11282 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11284 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11285 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11287 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11288 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11289 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11290 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11292 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11296 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11297 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11298 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11299 const char *addr_string,
11300 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11307 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11309 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11311 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11312 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11313 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11314 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11315 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11316 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11317 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11318 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11319 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11320 enough for now, though. */
11323 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11325 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11326 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11327 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11328 language_def (language_ada));
11329 b->language = language_ada;
11333 catch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11335 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11340 tcatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11342 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11345 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11348 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11350 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11351 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11353 if (a->number < b->number)
11355 else if (a->number > b->number)
11358 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11362 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11365 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11368 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11370 struct breakpoint *b;
11373 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11374 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11375 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11379 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11380 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11381 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11383 sals = decoded_sals;
11387 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11388 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11389 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11390 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11391 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11392 error (_("No source file specified."));
11398 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11399 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11400 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11401 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11403 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11404 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11405 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11406 due to optimization, all in one block.
11408 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11409 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11410 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11411 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11412 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11413 to support that. */
11415 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11416 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11417 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11420 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11421 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11423 const char *sal_fullname;
11425 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11426 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11427 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11430 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11435 1 0 <can't happen> */
11437 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11438 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11440 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11441 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11444 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11445 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11447 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11448 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11450 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11451 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11452 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11454 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11455 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11456 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11457 || loc->section == sal.section));
11458 int line_match = 0;
11460 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11461 && loc->symtab != NULL
11462 && sal_fullname != NULL
11463 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11464 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11465 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11466 sal_fullname) == 0)
11469 if (pc_match || line_match)
11478 found.push_back (b);
11482 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11483 if (found.empty ())
11486 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11488 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11491 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11492 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11493 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11495 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
11497 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11498 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11500 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
11504 if (found.size () > 1)
11505 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11508 if (found.size () == 1)
11509 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11511 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11514 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11517 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11518 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11521 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11524 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11525 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11526 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11529 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11531 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11533 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11534 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11535 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11537 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11539 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11541 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11542 delete_breakpoint (b);
11546 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11547 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11548 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
11549 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
11550 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
11551 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
11554 bp_locations_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11556 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
11557 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
11559 if (a->address != b->address)
11560 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
11562 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11563 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11566 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11567 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
11568 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
11570 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11571 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11572 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
11574 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11575 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11576 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11578 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11579 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
11580 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
11582 return (a > b) - (a < b);
11585 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11586 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11587 content of the bp_locations array. */
11590 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11592 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11594 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11595 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11597 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11599 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11601 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11604 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11605 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11607 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11608 addr = bl->address - start;
11609 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11610 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11612 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11614 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11615 addr = end - bl->address;
11616 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11617 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11621 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11624 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11626 struct breakpoint *b;
11627 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11629 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11631 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11633 struct bp_location *bl;
11634 struct tracepoint *t;
11635 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11637 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11638 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11639 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11642 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11644 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11645 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11647 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11650 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11653 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
11655 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11656 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11657 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11658 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11661 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11663 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11666 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11668 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11669 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11670 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11671 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11675 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11678 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11680 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11681 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11682 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11683 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11685 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11686 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11687 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11688 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11689 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11691 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11692 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11693 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11694 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11695 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11696 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11697 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11698 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11701 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11702 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11703 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11707 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11709 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11710 struct bp_location *loc;
11711 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11714 address = bl->address;
11715 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11717 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11718 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11719 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11721 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11722 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11725 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11726 the same program space as the location
11727 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11728 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11729 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11733 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11734 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11737 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11738 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11739 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11740 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11741 that have already been marked. */
11742 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11744 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11746 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11749 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11750 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11751 locations are duplicate of which.
11753 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11754 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11758 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11760 struct breakpoint *b;
11761 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11762 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11763 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11764 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11765 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11767 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11768 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11769 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11770 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11771 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11773 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11774 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11775 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11776 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11778 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11779 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11780 struct bp_location **old_locp;
11781 unsigned old_locations_count;
11782 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
11784 old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
11785 bp_locations = NULL;
11786 bp_locations_count = 0;
11788 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11789 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11790 bp_locations_count++;
11792 bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
11793 locp = bp_locations;
11794 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11795 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11797 qsort (bp_locations, bp_locations_count, sizeof (*bp_locations),
11798 bp_locations_compare);
11800 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11802 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11803 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11804 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11805 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11806 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11809 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11810 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11812 locp = bp_locations;
11813 for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
11814 old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
11817 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11818 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11820 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11821 not, we have to free it. */
11822 int found_object = 0;
11823 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11824 int keep_in_target = 0;
11827 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11828 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11829 while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11830 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
11834 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11835 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11838 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11839 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11840 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11842 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
11843 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11844 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11846 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
11847 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11850 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
11854 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11855 have to go through updates again. */
11856 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11858 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11860 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11862 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11863 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11864 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11865 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11866 at certain location is not inserted. */
11868 if (old_loc->inserted)
11870 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11873 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11875 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11876 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11877 keep_in_target = 1;
11881 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11882 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11883 remove its target-side condition. */
11885 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11886 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11887 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11888 this one from the target. */
11890 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11891 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
11894 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11895 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11898 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
11900 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11902 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11903 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11904 supported, but the latter are. */
11905 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11907 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11908 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11911 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11912 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11914 if (loc2 != old_loc
11915 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11917 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11918 keep_in_target = 1;
11926 if (!keep_in_target)
11928 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11930 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11931 this location on the global list, and try to
11932 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11933 reason why we will succeed next time.
11935 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11936 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11937 only after calling us. */
11938 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11939 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11940 old_loc->owner->number);
11948 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11949 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11951 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11952 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11953 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11954 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11955 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11956 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11957 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11958 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11959 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11960 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11961 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11962 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11963 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11964 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11967 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11968 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11970 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11971 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11972 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11973 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11974 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11975 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11976 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
11977 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
11978 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
11979 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
11980 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
11981 targets that do not support new thread events, like
11982 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
11985 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
11986 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
11987 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
11988 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
11990 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
11991 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
11992 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
11993 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
11994 traps we can no longer explain. */
11996 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
11997 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11999 moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
12003 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12004 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12009 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12010 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12011 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12012 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12013 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12014 are sorted first for the same address.
12016 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12017 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12019 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12020 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12021 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12022 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12023 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12025 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12027 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12030 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12031 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12032 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12033 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12034 `struct bp_location'. */
12035 || is_tracepoint (b))
12037 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12038 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12042 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12043 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12044 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12045 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12046 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12047 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12049 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12051 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12052 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12053 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12055 *loc_first_p = loc;
12056 loc->duplicate = 0;
12058 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12060 loc->needs_update = 1;
12061 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12062 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12068 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12069 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12070 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12072 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12073 loc->duplicate = 1;
12075 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12076 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12079 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12081 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12082 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12085 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12086 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12087 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12088 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12089 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12091 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12095 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12096 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12100 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12102 for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
12104 struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
12105 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12107 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12108 unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
12115 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12120 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12122 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12128 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12131 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12135 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12136 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12138 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12139 bs->old_val = NULL;
12140 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12144 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12146 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12148 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12150 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12154 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12158 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12160 struct value_print_options opts;
12162 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12164 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12166 if (b->loc == NULL)
12168 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12169 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12170 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12171 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12173 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12174 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12176 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12178 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12179 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12184 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12185 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12191 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12193 printf_filtered (" at ");
12194 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12197 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12199 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12201 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12202 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12203 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12204 b->loc->line_number);
12206 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12207 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12208 real situation somewhat. */
12209 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12210 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12215 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12217 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12219 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12224 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12227 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12229 xfree (self->function_name);
12232 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12237 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12239 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12241 xfree (this->cond_string);
12242 xfree (this->extra_string);
12243 xfree (this->filter);
12246 static struct bp_location *
12247 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12249 return new bp_location (&bp_location_ops, self);
12253 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12255 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12258 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12259 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12262 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12264 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12268 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12269 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12271 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12275 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12276 const address_space *aspace,
12278 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12280 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12284 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12289 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12293 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12295 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12298 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12302 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12304 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12307 static enum print_stop_action
12308 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12310 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12314 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12315 struct ui_out *uiout)
12321 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12323 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12327 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12329 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12333 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12334 (const struct event_location *location,
12335 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12336 enum bptype type_wanted)
12338 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12342 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12343 struct linespec_result *c,
12344 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12345 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12346 enum bptype type_wanted,
12347 enum bpdisp disposition,
12349 int task, int ignore_count,
12350 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12351 int from_tty, int enabled,
12352 int internal, unsigned flags)
12354 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12357 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12358 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12359 const struct event_location *location,
12360 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12362 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12365 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12368 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12373 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12376 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12378 /* Nothing to do. */
12381 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12383 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12384 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12385 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12386 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12387 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12388 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12389 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12390 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12391 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12393 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12394 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12395 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12396 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12397 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12398 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12399 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12400 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12403 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12406 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12408 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12409 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12411 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12412 delete_breakpoint (b);
12416 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12420 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12422 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12424 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12425 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12427 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12428 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12430 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12434 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12436 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12437 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12439 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12443 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12444 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12445 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12447 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12448 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12451 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12455 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12456 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12457 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12464 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12465 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12466 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12468 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12469 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12471 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12472 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12473 be set at the same address. */
12477 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12481 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12483 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12488 static enum print_stop_action
12489 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12491 struct breakpoint *b;
12492 const struct bp_location *bl;
12494 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12496 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12498 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12499 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12501 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12502 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12503 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12506 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12507 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12510 uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint ");
12512 uiout->text ("Breakpoint ");
12513 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12515 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12516 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12517 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12519 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
12520 uiout->text (", ");
12522 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12526 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12528 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12533 case bp_breakpoint:
12534 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12535 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12536 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12538 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12539 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12540 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12541 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12543 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12544 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12547 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12555 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12557 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12558 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12559 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12560 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12561 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12562 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12563 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12564 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12565 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12567 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12568 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12570 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12571 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12573 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12574 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12575 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12576 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12578 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12582 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12583 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12584 enum bptype type_wanted)
12586 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12590 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12591 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12592 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12593 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12594 enum bptype type_wanted,
12595 enum bpdisp disposition,
12597 int task, int ignore_count,
12598 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12599 int from_tty, int enabled,
12600 int internal, unsigned flags)
12602 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12603 std::move (cond_string),
12604 std::move (extra_string),
12606 disposition, thread, task,
12607 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12608 enabled, internal, flags);
12611 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12612 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12613 const struct event_location *location,
12614 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12616 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12619 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12622 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12626 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12627 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12628 case bp_overlay_event:
12629 case bp_longjmp_master:
12630 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12631 case bp_exception_master:
12632 delete_breakpoint (b);
12635 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12636 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12637 case bp_shlib_event:
12639 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12640 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12641 case bp_thread_event:
12647 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12649 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12651 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12652 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12653 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12654 objects (among other things). */
12655 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12656 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12662 static enum print_stop_action
12663 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12665 struct breakpoint *b;
12667 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12671 case bp_shlib_event:
12672 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12673 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12674 to shlib event" message.) */
12675 print_solib_event (0);
12678 case bp_thread_event:
12679 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12680 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12681 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12684 case bp_overlay_event:
12685 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12686 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12689 case bp_longjmp_master:
12690 /* These should never be enabled. */
12691 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12694 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12695 /* These should never be enabled. */
12696 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12697 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12700 case bp_exception_master:
12701 /* These should never be enabled. */
12702 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12703 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12707 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12711 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12713 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12716 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12719 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12721 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12722 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12723 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12724 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12728 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12730 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12733 static enum print_stop_action
12734 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12736 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12740 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12742 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12745 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12747 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12748 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12750 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12752 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12755 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12758 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12761 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12763 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12767 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12769 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12776 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12777 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12779 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12780 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12782 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12786 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12787 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12788 enum bptype type_wanted)
12790 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12792 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12794 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12795 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12798 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12799 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12800 const struct event_location *location,
12801 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12803 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12805 error (_("probe not found"));
12809 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12812 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12814 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12818 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12819 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12820 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12822 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12828 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12829 struct ui_out *uiout)
12831 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12832 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12834 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12836 uiout->text ("\tmarker id is ");
12837 uiout->field_string ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12838 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
12839 uiout->text ("\n");
12844 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12846 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12851 case bp_tracepoint:
12852 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12853 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12855 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12856 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12857 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12859 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12860 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12861 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12864 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12865 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12872 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12874 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12876 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12877 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12878 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12879 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12880 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12881 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12883 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12884 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12886 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12887 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12888 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12890 if (tp->pass_count)
12891 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12895 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12896 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12897 enum bptype type_wanted)
12899 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12903 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12904 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12905 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12906 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12907 enum bptype type_wanted,
12908 enum bpdisp disposition,
12910 int task, int ignore_count,
12911 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12912 int from_tty, int enabled,
12913 int internal, unsigned flags)
12915 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12916 std::move (cond_string),
12917 std::move (extra_string),
12919 disposition, thread, task,
12920 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12921 enabled, internal, flags);
12924 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12925 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12926 const struct event_location *location,
12927 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12929 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12932 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12934 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
12938 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12939 (const struct event_location *location,
12940 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12941 enum bptype type_wanted)
12943 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12944 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12947 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12948 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12949 const struct event_location *location,
12950 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12952 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12953 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12956 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
12958 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12961 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12963 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12965 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12966 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
12968 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
12969 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
12970 3 - disconnect from target 1
12971 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
12973 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
12974 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
12975 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
12976 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
12977 it all the time. */
12978 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
12979 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
12982 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
12985 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12987 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
12988 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
12990 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12993 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
12996 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
12997 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
12998 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
12999 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13000 address are all handled. */
13003 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13005 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
13006 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13008 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13009 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13010 condition not be evaluated. */
13013 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13014 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13015 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13016 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13017 commands here throws. */
13018 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13019 bs->commands = NULL;
13021 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13023 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13024 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13028 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13032 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13033 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13034 enum bptype type_wanted)
13036 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13037 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13039 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13040 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13042 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13043 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
13044 canonical->location
13045 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
13048 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
13049 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
13053 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13054 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13055 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13056 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13057 enum bptype type_wanted,
13058 enum bpdisp disposition,
13060 int task, int ignore_count,
13061 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13062 int from_tty, int enabled,
13063 int internal, unsigned flags)
13065 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
13067 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13068 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13069 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13070 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13071 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13072 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13074 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13076 event_location_up location
13077 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13079 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13080 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13081 std::move (location), NULL,
13082 std::move (cond_string),
13083 std::move (extra_string),
13084 type_wanted, disposition,
13085 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13086 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13087 canonical->special_display);
13088 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13089 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13090 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13091 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13092 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13093 corresponds to this one */
13094 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13096 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13100 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13101 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13102 const struct event_location *location,
13103 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13105 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13106 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13108 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13109 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13111 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13116 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13119 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13122 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13124 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13127 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13131 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13133 struct breakpoint *b;
13135 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13137 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13138 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13141 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13142 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13143 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13144 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13145 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13148 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13149 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13150 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13151 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13153 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13156 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13157 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13158 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13160 struct breakpoint *related;
13161 struct watchpoint *w;
13163 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13164 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13165 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13166 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13170 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13172 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13173 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13174 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13175 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13176 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13179 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13180 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13181 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13182 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13184 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
13186 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13187 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13189 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13190 if (b->next == bpt)
13192 b->next = bpt->next;
13196 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13198 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13199 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13200 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13201 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13202 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13203 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13204 commands won't work. */
13206 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13208 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13209 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13210 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13211 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13212 might be better design to have location completely
13213 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13214 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13216 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13217 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13218 bpt->type = bp_none;
13222 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13223 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13226 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13227 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13229 struct breakpoint *related;
13234 struct breakpoint *next;
13236 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13237 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13239 if (next == related)
13241 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13242 function (related);
13244 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13245 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13250 function (related);
13254 while (related != b);
13258 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13260 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13266 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13268 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13269 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13270 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13271 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13272 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13274 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13278 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13280 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13282 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13283 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13284 delete_breakpoint (b);
13288 map_breakpoint_numbers
13289 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
13291 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
13295 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13296 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13300 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13302 struct bp_location *loc;
13304 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13305 if ((pspace == NULL
13306 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13307 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13308 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13313 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13314 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13315 Null names are ignored. */
13318 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13320 struct bp_location *l;
13321 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, streq_hash, NULL,
13324 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13327 const char *name = l->function_name;
13329 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13333 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13335 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13339 htab_delete (htab);
13345 htab_delete (htab);
13349 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13350 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13351 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13352 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13353 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13354 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13355 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13356 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13359 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13360 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13361 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13362 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13363 in the sources, and output a warning.
13365 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13366 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13367 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13368 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13369 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13372 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13373 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13374 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13375 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13376 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13377 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13378 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13379 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13380 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13382 static struct symtab_and_line
13383 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13385 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13386 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13391 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13393 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13395 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
13396 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13397 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
13398 marker.str_id.c_str ());
13400 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
13405 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13407 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13409 && sal.symtab != NULL
13410 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
13412 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
13413 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13414 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13416 if (!markers.empty ())
13418 struct symbol *sym;
13419 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13420 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13421 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13423 tpmarker = &markers[0];
13425 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
13427 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13428 "found at previous line number"),
13429 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13431 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13432 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13433 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13436 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
13437 uiout->text (" at ");
13439 uiout->field_string ("file",
13440 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13443 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13445 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13447 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13450 uiout->field_int ("line", sal2.line);
13451 uiout->text ("\n");
13453 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13454 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13456 b->location.reset (NULL);
13457 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13458 explicit_loc.source_filename
13459 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13460 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13461 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13462 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13464 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13471 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13472 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13475 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13479 if (a->address != b->address)
13482 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13485 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13492 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13498 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13499 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13500 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13502 static struct bp_location *
13503 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13505 struct bp_location head;
13506 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13507 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13508 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13510 if (pspace == NULL)
13521 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13536 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13537 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13538 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13539 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13543 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13544 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13545 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13546 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13548 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13550 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13552 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13554 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13555 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13556 "multiple locations found\n"),
13561 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13562 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13563 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13564 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13565 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13566 individual locations. */
13567 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13570 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13572 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13574 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13576 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13578 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13580 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13582 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13586 s = b->cond_string;
13589 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13590 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13593 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13595 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13596 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13597 b->number, e.message);
13598 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13603 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13605 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13607 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13611 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13614 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13615 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13616 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13617 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13618 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13619 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13620 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13622 for (; e; e = e->next)
13624 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13626 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13627 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13629 for (; l; l = l->next)
13630 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13638 for (; l; l = l->next)
13639 if (l->function_name
13640 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13650 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13651 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13654 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13655 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13657 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13658 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13659 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13661 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
13663 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13665 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13669 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13671 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13673 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13677 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13678 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13679 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13680 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13681 state, then user already saw the message about that
13682 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13684 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13685 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13687 && search_pspace != NULL
13688 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13689 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13690 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13691 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13692 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13694 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13696 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13697 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13698 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13699 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13700 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13701 which approach is better. */
13702 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13703 throw_exception (e);
13708 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13710 for (auto &sal : sals)
13711 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13712 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13714 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13717 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
13718 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13720 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13722 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13723 b->thread = thread;
13727 xfree (b->extra_string);
13728 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13730 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13733 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13734 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13744 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13745 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13749 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13751 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13752 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13755 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13756 filter_pspace, &found);
13758 expanded = std::move (sals);
13760 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13762 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13763 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13764 filter_pspace, &found);
13766 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13769 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13772 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13773 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13776 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
13777 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13778 enum bptype type_wanted)
13780 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13783 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13784 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13788 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13789 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13790 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13791 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13792 enum bptype type_wanted,
13793 enum bpdisp disposition,
13795 int task, int ignore_count,
13796 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13797 int from_tty, int enabled,
13798 int internal, unsigned flags)
13800 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13801 std::move (cond_string),
13802 std::move (extra_string),
13803 type_wanted, disposition,
13804 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13805 enabled, internal, flags);
13808 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13809 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13811 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13812 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13813 const struct event_location *location,
13814 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13816 struct linespec_result canonical;
13818 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13819 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
13820 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13823 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13824 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13826 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13828 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13829 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13834 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13837 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13839 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13840 set_language (b->language);
13842 b->ops->re_set (b);
13845 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13846 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13849 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13851 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13854 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13855 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13856 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13858 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13859 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13860 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13861 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13862 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13863 we select the current frame.
13865 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13866 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13867 have been reset. */
13868 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13869 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13871 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13872 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13873 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13874 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13876 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13880 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13882 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
13884 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13885 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13891 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13894 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13895 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13896 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13897 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13899 /* Now we can insert. */
13900 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13903 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13905 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13906 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13908 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13910 if (b->thread != -1)
13912 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13914 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13915 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13916 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13918 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13922 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13923 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13924 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13927 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13929 struct breakpoint *b;
13934 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13935 if (b->number == bptnum)
13937 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13939 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13940 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13945 b->ignore_count = count;
13949 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13950 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13952 else if (count == 1)
13953 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13956 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13957 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13960 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13964 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13967 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13970 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13972 const char *p = args;
13976 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
13978 num = get_number (&p);
13980 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
13982 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
13984 set_ignore_count (num,
13985 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
13988 printf_filtered ("\n");
13992 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
13993 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
13996 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
13997 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13999 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
14001 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
14002 bp_num_range.first);
14006 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14008 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
14010 bool match = false;
14012 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14013 if (b->number == i)
14020 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
14025 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
14029 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
14030 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14032 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14033 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14035 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14037 while (!parser.finished ())
14039 int num = parser.get_number ();
14040 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
14044 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
14045 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
14047 static struct bp_location *
14048 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
14050 struct breakpoint *b;
14052 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14053 if (b->number == bp_num)
14058 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14059 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
14062 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14065 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14066 if (++n == loc_num)
14069 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14072 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14073 enum class extract_bp_kind
14075 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14078 /* Extracting a location number. */
14082 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14083 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14084 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14085 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14086 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14089 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14090 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14092 const char *end = start;
14093 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14095 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14096 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14097 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14098 int (end - start), start);
14100 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14101 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14102 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14103 int (end - start), start);
14105 if (end_out != NULL)
14110 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14111 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14112 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14113 are always positive integers. */
14115 static std::pair<int, int>
14116 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14117 const std::string &arg,
14118 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14120 std::pair<int, int> range;
14121 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14122 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14123 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14125 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14126 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14127 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14128 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14129 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14133 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14134 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14135 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14136 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14138 if (range.first > range.second)
14139 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14140 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14141 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14142 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14146 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14147 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14148 range.second = range.first;
14153 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14154 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14157 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14159 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14160 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14161 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14162 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14163 location number range.
14167 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14168 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14169 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14171 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14173 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14175 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14177 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14178 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14181 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14182 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14184 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14189 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14191 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14192 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14193 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14197 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14198 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14201 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14203 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14206 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14208 loc->enabled = enable;
14209 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14211 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14212 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14213 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14214 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14216 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14218 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
14221 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14222 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14223 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14224 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14228 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14229 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14232 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14233 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14236 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14237 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14238 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14241 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14243 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14244 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14245 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14246 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14249 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14251 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14252 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14254 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14255 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14257 struct bp_location *location;
14259 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14260 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14263 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14265 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14268 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14269 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14270 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14271 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14274 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14278 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14280 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14281 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14284 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14286 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14291 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14293 while (!num.empty ())
14295 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14297 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14299 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14300 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14302 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14303 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14305 ? enable_breakpoint
14306 : disable_breakpoint);
14310 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14312 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14313 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14315 num = extract_arg (&args);
14320 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14321 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14322 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14323 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14326 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14328 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14332 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14335 int target_resources_ok;
14337 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14340 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14341 target_resources_ok =
14342 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14344 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14345 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14346 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14347 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14350 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14352 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14353 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14357 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14359 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14360 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14361 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14363 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14365 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14366 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14373 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14375 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14376 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14378 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14379 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14381 struct bp_location *location;
14383 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14384 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14387 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14388 bpt->enable_count = count;
14389 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14391 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14396 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14398 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14401 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14402 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14403 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14404 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14407 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14409 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14413 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14415 map_breakpoint_numbers
14416 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14418 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14419 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14421 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14427 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14432 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14434 count = get_number (&args);
14436 map_breakpoint_numbers
14437 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14439 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14440 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14442 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14448 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14450 map_breakpoint_numbers
14451 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14453 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14454 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14456 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14462 set_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14467 show_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14471 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14472 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14476 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14477 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14478 const bfd_byte *data)
14480 struct breakpoint *bp;
14482 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14483 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14484 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14486 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14488 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
14490 struct bp_location *loc;
14492 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14493 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14494 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14495 && addr + len > loc->address)
14504 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14507 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14508 const address_space *aspace,
14511 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14512 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14513 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14515 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14517 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14518 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14521 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14523 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14524 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14525 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14527 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14530 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14533 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14535 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14536 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14538 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14540 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14542 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14543 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14545 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14546 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14554 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14557 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14558 const address_space *aspace,
14561 struct bp_location *loc;
14563 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14565 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14571 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14575 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14578 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14580 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14582 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14583 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14589 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14591 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14593 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14595 tracepoint_count = num;
14596 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14600 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14602 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14604 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14606 if (location != NULL
14607 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
14608 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14610 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14612 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14614 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14616 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14617 0 /* Ignore count */,
14618 pending_break_support,
14622 0 /* internal */, 0);
14626 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14628 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14630 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14632 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14634 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14635 0 /* Ignore count */,
14636 pending_break_support,
14637 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14640 0 /* internal */, 0);
14643 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14646 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14648 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14649 event_location_up location;
14651 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14652 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14653 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14655 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14656 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14660 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14661 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14664 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14666 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14668 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14669 0 /* Ignore count */,
14670 pending_break_support,
14674 0 /* internal */, 0);
14677 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14678 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14680 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14681 static int next_cmd;
14684 read_uploaded_action (void)
14686 char *rslt = nullptr;
14688 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14690 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd];
14697 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14698 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14699 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14700 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14701 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14703 struct tracepoint *
14704 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14706 const char *addr_str;
14707 char small_buf[100];
14708 struct tracepoint *tp;
14710 if (utp->at_string)
14711 addr_str = utp->at_string;
14714 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14715 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14716 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14718 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14719 "source location, using raw address"),
14721 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14722 addr_str = small_buf;
14725 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14726 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14727 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14728 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14731 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14733 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14735 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
14736 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14738 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14739 0 /* Ignore count */,
14740 pending_break_support,
14741 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14743 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14745 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14748 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14749 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14750 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14754 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14757 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14760 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14761 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14762 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14764 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14766 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14771 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14773 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14775 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14776 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14777 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14778 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14781 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14782 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14783 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14788 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14792 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14794 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14797 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
14799 if (num_printed == 0)
14801 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14802 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14804 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14807 default_collect_info ();
14810 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14811 Not supported by all targets. */
14813 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14815 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14818 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14819 Not supported by all targets. */
14821 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14823 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14826 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14828 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14830 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14836 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14838 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14839 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14840 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14842 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14843 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14845 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14849 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14851 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14853 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14854 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14855 delete_breakpoint (b);
14859 map_breakpoint_numbers
14860 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
14862 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
14866 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14869 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14871 tp->pass_count = count;
14872 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14874 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14875 tp->number, count);
14878 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14880 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14881 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14882 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14885 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14887 struct tracepoint *t1;
14890 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14891 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14892 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14894 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14896 args = skip_spaces (args);
14897 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14899 struct breakpoint *b;
14901 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14903 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14905 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14907 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14908 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14911 else if (*args == '\0')
14913 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14915 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14919 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14920 while (!parser.finished ())
14922 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14924 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14929 struct tracepoint *
14930 get_tracepoint (int num)
14932 struct breakpoint *t;
14934 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14935 if (t->number == num)
14936 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14941 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14942 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14945 struct tracepoint *
14946 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14948 struct breakpoint *b;
14950 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14952 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14954 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14961 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14962 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14963 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14964 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14966 struct tracepoint *
14967 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14968 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14970 struct breakpoint *t;
14972 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14974 if (parser != NULL)
14976 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14977 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14979 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14980 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14982 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14986 if (instring && *instring)
14987 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14990 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14994 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14995 if (t->number == tpnum)
14997 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15000 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15005 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15007 if (b->thread != -1)
15008 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15011 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15013 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15016 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15017 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15018 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15022 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
15023 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15025 struct breakpoint *tp;
15027 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15029 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15030 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15032 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15033 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15035 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15036 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15039 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15040 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15045 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15047 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15049 /* We can stop searching. */
15056 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15060 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
15064 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
15065 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15066 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
15068 if (extra_trace_bits)
15069 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
15071 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15073 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15074 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15077 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15078 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15081 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15083 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15084 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15087 if (tp->cond_string)
15088 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15090 if (tp->ignore_count)
15091 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15093 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15095 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15097 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15100 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15102 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15104 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15105 throw_exception (ex);
15109 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15110 fp.puts (" end\n");
15113 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15114 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15116 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15117 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15118 special, and not user visible. */
15119 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15121 struct bp_location *loc;
15124 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15126 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15130 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15131 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15134 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15137 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15140 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15142 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15145 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15148 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15150 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15153 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15155 std::vector<breakpoint *>
15156 all_tracepoints (void)
15158 std::vector<breakpoint *> tp_vec;
15159 struct breakpoint *tp;
15161 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15163 tp_vec.push_back (tp);
15170 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15171 locations used by several commands. */
15173 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15174 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15175 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15176 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15177 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15178 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15180 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15181 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15182 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15184 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15185 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15186 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15187 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15188 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15190 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15191 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15192 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15193 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15194 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15195 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead.\n"
15197 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15198 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15199 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15202 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15203 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15204 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15205 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15206 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15207 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15208 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15211 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15212 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15214 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15215 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15216 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15217 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15218 conditions are different.\n\
15220 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15222 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15223 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15225 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15226 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15229 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15230 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15231 completer_ftype *completer,
15232 void *user_data_catch,
15233 void *user_data_tcatch)
15235 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15237 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15239 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15240 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15241 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15243 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15245 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15246 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15247 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15251 save_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
15253 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15254 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15255 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15258 struct breakpoint *
15259 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15262 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15264 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15266 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15273 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15274 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15277 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15279 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15280 non-inline function. */
15281 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15287 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15288 have been inlined. */
15291 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15292 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15294 struct breakpoint *b;
15295 struct bp_location *bl;
15297 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15299 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15302 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15304 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15305 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15313 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15316 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15318 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15320 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15321 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15322 loc->symtab = NULL;
15326 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15328 static int initialized = 0;
15330 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15336 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15337 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15338 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15339 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15340 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15341 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15342 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15343 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15344 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15345 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15346 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15347 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15349 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15350 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15351 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15352 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15353 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15354 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15355 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15356 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15358 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15359 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15360 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15361 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15362 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15363 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15364 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15365 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15366 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15367 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15369 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15370 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15371 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15372 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15373 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15374 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15375 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15377 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15378 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15379 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15380 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15381 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15382 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15383 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15385 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15386 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15387 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15388 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15389 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15390 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15391 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15394 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15395 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15396 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15397 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15398 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15399 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15400 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15401 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15402 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15403 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15404 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15405 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15406 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15408 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15409 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15410 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15411 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15412 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15413 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15414 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15415 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15416 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15417 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15418 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15421 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15422 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15423 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15424 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15425 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15426 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15427 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15428 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15429 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15430 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15432 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15433 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15434 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15435 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15436 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15438 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15439 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15440 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15441 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15442 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15443 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15445 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15446 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15447 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15448 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15449 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15450 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15451 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15452 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15453 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15454 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15456 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15457 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15458 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15459 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15460 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15461 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15462 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15463 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15464 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15465 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15467 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15468 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15469 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15470 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15471 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15472 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15473 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15474 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15475 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15476 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15478 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15479 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15480 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15481 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15482 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15483 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15484 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15485 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15486 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15487 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15488 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15490 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15491 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15492 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15493 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15494 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15495 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15496 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15497 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15498 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15501 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15503 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15505 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15507 cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
15510 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15512 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15514 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15516 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15517 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15518 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15520 breakpoint_objfile_key
15521 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_objfile_data);
15523 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15524 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15525 before a breakpoint is set. */
15526 breakpoint_count = 0;
15528 tracepoint_count = 0;
15530 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15531 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15532 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15534 commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
15535 commands_command, _("\
15536 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15537 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15538 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15540 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15541 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15542 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15543 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15544 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15546 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15547 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15548 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15549 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15550 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15552 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15553 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15554 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15555 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15556 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15558 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15559 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15561 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15562 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15563 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15564 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15566 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15567 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15569 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15570 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15571 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15572 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15574 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15575 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15577 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15578 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15579 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15580 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15581 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15582 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15583 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15585 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15587 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15588 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15589 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15590 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15591 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15592 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15594 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15595 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15596 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15599 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15600 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15601 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15604 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15605 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15606 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15607 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15610 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15611 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15612 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15615 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15616 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15617 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15620 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15621 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15622 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15623 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15626 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15627 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15628 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15629 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15630 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15631 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15632 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15633 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15635 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15636 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15637 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15638 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15639 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15640 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15643 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15644 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15645 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15646 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15648 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
15649 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
15650 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15651 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15652 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15654 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15655 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15656 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15657 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15658 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15661 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15662 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15663 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15665 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15666 is executing in.\n"
15667 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15668 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15669 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15671 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15672 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15673 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15674 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15676 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15677 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15678 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15679 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15683 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15684 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15685 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15686 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15687 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15688 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15689 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15690 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15691 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15692 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15693 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15694 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15695 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15696 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15697 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15698 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15700 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15701 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15702 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15703 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15704 breakpoint set."));
15707 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15708 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15709 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15710 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15711 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15712 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15713 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15714 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15715 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15717 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15718 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15719 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15720 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15721 breakpoint set."));
15723 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15725 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15726 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15727 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15728 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15729 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15730 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15731 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15732 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15733 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15734 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15735 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15736 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15737 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15739 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15740 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15741 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15742 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15744 &maintenanceinfolist);
15746 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15747 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15748 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15749 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15751 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15752 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15753 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15754 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15756 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15757 catch_fork_command_1,
15759 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15760 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15761 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15762 catch_fork_command_1,
15764 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15765 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15766 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15767 catch_exec_command_1,
15771 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15772 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15773 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15774 catch_load_command_1,
15778 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15779 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15780 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15781 catch_unload_command_1,
15786 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15787 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15788 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15789 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15790 an expression changes.\n\
15791 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15792 the memory to which it refers."));
15793 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15795 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
15796 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15797 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15798 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15799 an expression is read.\n\
15800 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15801 the memory to which it refers."));
15802 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15804 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
15805 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15806 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15807 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15808 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15809 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15810 the memory to which it refers."));
15811 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15813 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15814 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15816 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15817 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15818 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15819 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15820 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15821 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15822 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15823 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15824 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15827 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15828 &setlist, &showlist);
15830 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15832 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15834 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15835 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15837 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15838 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15839 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15841 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
15842 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15843 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15844 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15846 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15847 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15849 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15850 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15851 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15853 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15854 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15856 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15857 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15858 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15859 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15860 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15861 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15862 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15863 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15864 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15866 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15867 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15868 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15869 conditions are different.\n\
15871 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15872 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15873 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15875 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15876 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15877 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15878 last tracepoint set."));
15880 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
15882 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15883 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15884 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15885 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15887 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15889 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15890 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15891 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15892 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15894 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15896 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15897 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15898 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15899 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15901 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15903 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15904 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15905 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15906 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15907 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15909 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
15910 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15911 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
15912 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15914 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15915 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15916 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15917 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15918 session to restore them."),
15920 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15922 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15923 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15924 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15926 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15928 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
15929 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15931 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15932 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15933 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15934 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15935 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
15936 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
15937 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15938 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15939 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15940 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15941 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
15942 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
15944 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15945 &pending_break_support, _("\
15946 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15947 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15948 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15949 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15950 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15951 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15953 show_pending_break_support,
15954 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15955 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15957 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15959 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15960 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15961 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15962 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15963 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15964 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15965 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15967 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15968 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15969 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15971 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15972 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15973 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15974 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15975 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15976 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15977 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15978 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15979 when execution stops."),
15981 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15982 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15983 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15985 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15986 condition_evaluation_enums,
15987 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15988 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15989 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15990 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15991 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15992 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15993 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15994 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15995 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15996 be set to \"gdb\""),
15997 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
15998 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
15999 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16000 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16002 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16003 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16004 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16005 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16006 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16007 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16008 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16009 or the start of the range\n\
16010 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16011 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16012 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16014 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16015 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16016 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16018 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16019 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16020 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16021 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16022 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16023 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16025 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16026 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16027 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16028 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16029 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16030 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16031 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16032 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16033 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16034 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16035 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16036 &setlist, &showlist);
16038 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16039 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16040 &dprintf_function, _("\
16041 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16042 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16043 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16044 &setlist, &showlist);
16046 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16047 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16048 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16049 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16050 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16051 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16052 &setlist, &showlist);
16054 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16055 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16056 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16057 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16058 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16059 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16062 &setlist, &showlist);
16064 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16065 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16066 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16068 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16070 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16071 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints);